]> git.saurik.com Git - wxWidgets.git/blob - src/generic/grid.cpp
don't use deprecated toolbar API
[wxWidgets.git] / src / generic / grid.cpp
1 ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 // Name: src/generic/grid.cpp
3 // Purpose: wxGrid and related classes
4 // Author: Michael Bedward (based on code by Julian Smart, Robin Dunn)
5 // Modified by: Robin Dunn, Vadim Zeitlin, Santiago Palacios
6 // Created: 1/08/1999
7 // RCS-ID: $Id$
8 // Copyright: (c) Michael Bedward (mbedward@ozemail.com.au)
9 // Licence: wxWindows licence
10 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 // For compilers that support precompilation, includes "wx/wx.h".
13 #include "wx/wxprec.h"
14
15 #ifdef __BORLANDC__
16 #pragma hdrstop
17 #endif
18
19 #if wxUSE_GRID
20
21 #include "wx/grid.h"
22
23 #ifndef WX_PRECOMP
24 #include "wx/utils.h"
25 #include "wx/dcclient.h"
26 #include "wx/settings.h"
27 #include "wx/log.h"
28 #include "wx/textctrl.h"
29 #include "wx/checkbox.h"
30 #include "wx/combobox.h"
31 #include "wx/valtext.h"
32 #include "wx/intl.h"
33 #include "wx/math.h"
34 #include "wx/listbox.h"
35 #endif
36
37 #include "wx/textfile.h"
38 #include "wx/spinctrl.h"
39 #include "wx/tokenzr.h"
40 #include "wx/renderer.h"
41
42 #include "wx/generic/gridsel.h"
43
44 const wxChar wxGridNameStr[] = wxT("grid");
45
46 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
47 #define WXUNUSED_MOTIF(identifier) WXUNUSED(identifier)
48 #else
49 #define WXUNUSED_MOTIF(identifier) identifier
50 #endif
51
52 #if defined(__WXGTK__)
53 #define WXUNUSED_GTK(identifier) WXUNUSED(identifier)
54 #else
55 #define WXUNUSED_GTK(identifier) identifier
56 #endif
57
58 // Required for wxIs... functions
59 #include <ctype.h>
60
61 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
62 // array classes
63 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
64
65 WX_DEFINE_ARRAY_WITH_DECL_PTR(wxGridCellAttr *, wxArrayAttrs,
66 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV);
67
68 struct wxGridCellWithAttr
69 {
70 wxGridCellWithAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr_)
71 : coords(row, col), attr(attr_)
72 {
73 wxASSERT( attr );
74 }
75
76 wxGridCellWithAttr(const wxGridCellWithAttr& other)
77 : coords(other.coords),
78 attr(other.attr)
79 {
80 attr->IncRef();
81 }
82
83 wxGridCellWithAttr& operator=(const wxGridCellWithAttr& other)
84 {
85 coords = other.coords;
86 if (attr != other.attr)
87 {
88 attr->DecRef();
89 attr = other.attr;
90 attr->IncRef();
91 }
92 return *this;
93 }
94
95 void ChangeAttr(wxGridCellAttr* new_attr)
96 {
97 if (attr != new_attr)
98 {
99 // "Delete" (i.e. DecRef) the old attribute.
100 attr->DecRef();
101 attr = new_attr;
102 // Take ownership of the new attribute, i.e. no IncRef.
103 }
104 }
105
106 ~wxGridCellWithAttr()
107 {
108 attr->DecRef();
109 }
110
111 wxGridCellCoords coords;
112 wxGridCellAttr *attr;
113 };
114
115 WX_DECLARE_OBJARRAY_WITH_DECL(wxGridCellWithAttr, wxGridCellWithAttrArray,
116 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV);
117
118 #include "wx/arrimpl.cpp"
119
120 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxGridCellCoordsArray)
121 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxGridCellWithAttrArray)
122
123 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
124 // events
125 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
126
127 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_CLICK)
128 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_CLICK)
129 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_DCLICK)
130 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_DCLICK)
131 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_BEGIN_DRAG)
132 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK)
133 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK)
134 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK)
135 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK)
136 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE)
137 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE)
138 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_COL_MOVE)
139 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_RANGE_SELECT)
140 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_CELL_CHANGE)
141 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_SELECT_CELL)
142 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_SHOWN)
143 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_HIDDEN)
144 DEFINE_EVENT_TYPE(wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_CREATED)
145
146 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
147 // private classes
148 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
149
150 // common base class for various grid subwindows
151 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridSubwindow : public wxWindow
152 {
153 public:
154 wxGridSubwindow() { m_owner = NULL; }
155 wxGridSubwindow(wxGrid *owner,
156 wxWindowID id,
157 const wxPoint& pos,
158 const wxSize& size,
159 int additionalStyle = 0,
160 const wxString& name = wxPanelNameStr)
161 : wxWindow(owner, id, pos, size,
162 wxBORDER_NONE | additionalStyle,
163 name)
164 {
165 m_owner = owner;
166 }
167
168 virtual bool AcceptsFocus() const { return false; }
169
170 wxGrid *GetOwner() { return m_owner; }
171
172 protected:
173 void OnMouseCaptureLost(wxMouseCaptureLostEvent& event);
174
175 wxGrid *m_owner;
176
177 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
178 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridSubwindow)
179 };
180
181 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridRowLabelWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
182 {
183 public:
184 wxGridRowLabelWindow() { }
185 wxGridRowLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent, wxWindowID id,
186 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
187
188 private:
189 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& event );
190 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
191 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
192
193 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridRowLabelWindow)
194 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
195 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridRowLabelWindow)
196 };
197
198
199 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridColLabelWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
200 {
201 public:
202 wxGridColLabelWindow() { }
203 wxGridColLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent, wxWindowID id,
204 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
205
206 private:
207 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& event );
208 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
209 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
210
211 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridColLabelWindow)
212 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
213 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridColLabelWindow)
214 };
215
216
217 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridCornerLabelWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
218 {
219 public:
220 wxGridCornerLabelWindow() { }
221 wxGridCornerLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent, wxWindowID id,
222 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
223
224 private:
225 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
226 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
227 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& event );
228
229 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridCornerLabelWindow)
230 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
231 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridCornerLabelWindow)
232 };
233
234 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridWindow : public wxGridSubwindow
235 {
236 public:
237 wxGridWindow()
238 {
239 m_rowLabelWin = NULL;
240 m_colLabelWin = NULL;
241 }
242
243 wxGridWindow( wxGrid *parent,
244 wxGridRowLabelWindow *rowLblWin,
245 wxGridColLabelWindow *colLblWin,
246 wxWindowID id, const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size );
247
248 void ScrollWindow( int dx, int dy, const wxRect *rect );
249
250 virtual bool AcceptsFocus() const { return true; }
251
252 private:
253 wxGridRowLabelWindow *m_rowLabelWin;
254 wxGridColLabelWindow *m_colLabelWin;
255
256 void OnPaint( wxPaintEvent &event );
257 void OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event );
258 void OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event );
259 void OnKeyDown( wxKeyEvent& );
260 void OnKeyUp( wxKeyEvent& );
261 void OnChar( wxKeyEvent& );
262 void OnEraseBackground( wxEraseEvent& );
263 void OnFocus( wxFocusEvent& );
264
265 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridWindow)
266 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
267 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridWindow)
268 };
269
270
271 class wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler : public wxEvtHandler
272 {
273 public:
274 wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler(wxGrid* grid, wxGridCellEditor* editor)
275 : m_grid(grid),
276 m_editor(editor),
277 m_inSetFocus(false)
278 {
279 }
280
281 void OnKillFocus(wxFocusEvent& event);
282 void OnKeyDown(wxKeyEvent& event);
283 void OnChar(wxKeyEvent& event);
284
285 void SetInSetFocus(bool inSetFocus) { m_inSetFocus = inSetFocus; }
286
287 private:
288 wxGrid *m_grid;
289 wxGridCellEditor *m_editor;
290
291 // Work around the fact that a focus kill event can be sent to
292 // a combobox within a set focus event.
293 bool m_inSetFocus;
294
295 DECLARE_EVENT_TABLE()
296 DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler)
297 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler)
298 };
299
300
301 IMPLEMENT_ABSTRACT_CLASS(wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler, wxEvtHandler)
302
303 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler, wxEvtHandler )
304 EVT_KILL_FOCUS( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKillFocus )
305 EVT_KEY_DOWN( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKeyDown )
306 EVT_CHAR( wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnChar )
307 END_EVENT_TABLE()
308
309
310 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
311 // the internal data representation used by wxGridCellAttrProvider
312 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
313
314 // this class stores attributes set for cells
315 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridCellAttrData
316 {
317 public:
318 void SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row, int col);
319 wxGridCellAttr *GetAttr(int row, int col) const;
320 void UpdateAttrRows( size_t pos, int numRows );
321 void UpdateAttrCols( size_t pos, int numCols );
322
323 private:
324 // searches for the attr for given cell, returns wxNOT_FOUND if not found
325 int FindIndex(int row, int col) const;
326
327 wxGridCellWithAttrArray m_attrs;
328 };
329
330 // this class stores attributes set for rows or columns
331 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridRowOrColAttrData
332 {
333 public:
334 // empty ctor to suppress warnings
335 wxGridRowOrColAttrData() {}
336 ~wxGridRowOrColAttrData();
337
338 void SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int rowOrCol);
339 wxGridCellAttr *GetAttr(int rowOrCol) const;
340 void UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( size_t pos, int numRowsOrCols );
341
342 private:
343 wxArrayInt m_rowsOrCols;
344 wxArrayAttrs m_attrs;
345 };
346
347 // NB: this is just a wrapper around 3 objects: one which stores cell
348 // attributes, and 2 others for row/col ones
349 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridCellAttrProviderData
350 {
351 public:
352 wxGridCellAttrData m_cellAttrs;
353 wxGridRowOrColAttrData m_rowAttrs,
354 m_colAttrs;
355 };
356
357
358 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
359 // data structures used for the data type registry
360 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
361
362 struct wxGridDataTypeInfo
363 {
364 wxGridDataTypeInfo(const wxString& typeName,
365 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
366 wxGridCellEditor* editor)
367 : m_typeName(typeName), m_renderer(renderer), m_editor(editor)
368 {}
369
370 ~wxGridDataTypeInfo()
371 {
372 wxSafeDecRef(m_renderer);
373 wxSafeDecRef(m_editor);
374 }
375
376 wxString m_typeName;
377 wxGridCellRenderer* m_renderer;
378 wxGridCellEditor* m_editor;
379
380 DECLARE_NO_COPY_CLASS(wxGridDataTypeInfo)
381 };
382
383
384 WX_DEFINE_ARRAY_WITH_DECL_PTR(wxGridDataTypeInfo*, wxGridDataTypeInfoArray,
385 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV);
386
387
388 class WXDLLIMPEXP_ADV wxGridTypeRegistry
389 {
390 public:
391 wxGridTypeRegistry() {}
392 ~wxGridTypeRegistry();
393
394 void RegisterDataType(const wxString& typeName,
395 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
396 wxGridCellEditor* editor);
397
398 // find one of already registered data types
399 int FindRegisteredDataType(const wxString& typeName);
400
401 // try to FindRegisteredDataType(), if this fails and typeName is one of
402 // standard typenames, register it and return its index
403 int FindDataType(const wxString& typeName);
404
405 // try to FindDataType(), if it fails see if it is not one of already
406 // registered data types with some params in which case clone the
407 // registered data type and set params for it
408 int FindOrCloneDataType(const wxString& typeName);
409
410 wxGridCellRenderer* GetRenderer(int index);
411 wxGridCellEditor* GetEditor(int index);
412
413 private:
414 wxGridDataTypeInfoArray m_typeinfo;
415 };
416
417
418 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
419 // conditional compilation
420 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
421
422 #ifndef WXGRID_DRAW_LINES
423 #define WXGRID_DRAW_LINES 1
424 #endif
425
426 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
427 // globals
428 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
429
430 //#define DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
431 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
432 static size_t gs_nAttrCacheHits = 0;
433 static size_t gs_nAttrCacheMisses = 0;
434 #endif
435
436 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
437 // constants
438 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
439
440 wxGridCellCoords wxGridNoCellCoords( -1, -1 );
441 wxRect wxGridNoCellRect( -1, -1, -1, -1 );
442
443 // scroll line size
444 // TODO: this doesn't work at all, grid cells have different sizes and approx
445 // calculations don't work as because of the size mismatch scrollbars
446 // sometimes fail to be shown when they should be or vice versa
447 //
448 // The scroll bars may be a little flakey once in a while, but that is
449 // surely much less horrible than having scroll lines of only 1!!!
450 // -- Robin
451 //
452 // Well, it's still seriously broken so it might be better but needs
453 // fixing anyhow
454 // -- Vadim
455 static const size_t GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X = 15; // 1;
456 static const size_t GRID_SCROLL_LINE_Y = GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X;
457
458 // the size of hash tables used a bit everywhere (the max number of elements
459 // in these hash tables is the number of rows/columns)
460 static const int GRID_HASH_SIZE = 100;
461
462 #if 0
463 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
464 // private functions
465 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
466
467 static inline int GetScrollX(int x)
468 {
469 return (x + GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X - 1) / GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X;
470 }
471
472 static inline int GetScrollY(int y)
473 {
474 return (y + GRID_SCROLL_LINE_Y - 1) / GRID_SCROLL_LINE_Y;
475 }
476 #endif
477
478 // ============================================================================
479 // implementation
480 // ============================================================================
481
482 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
483 // wxGridCellEditor
484 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
485
486 wxGridCellEditor::wxGridCellEditor()
487 {
488 m_control = NULL;
489 m_attr = NULL;
490 }
491
492 wxGridCellEditor::~wxGridCellEditor()
493 {
494 Destroy();
495 }
496
497 void wxGridCellEditor::Create(wxWindow* WXUNUSED(parent),
498 wxWindowID WXUNUSED(id),
499 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
500 {
501 if ( evtHandler )
502 m_control->PushEventHandler(evtHandler);
503 }
504
505 void wxGridCellEditor::PaintBackground(const wxRect& rectCell,
506 wxGridCellAttr *attr)
507 {
508 // erase the background because we might not fill the cell
509 wxClientDC dc(m_control->GetParent());
510 wxGridWindow* gridWindow = wxDynamicCast(m_control->GetParent(), wxGridWindow);
511 if (gridWindow)
512 gridWindow->GetOwner()->PrepareDC(dc);
513
514 dc.SetPen(*wxTRANSPARENT_PEN);
515 dc.SetBrush(wxBrush(attr->GetBackgroundColour(), wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID));
516 dc.DrawRectangle(rectCell);
517
518 // redraw the control we just painted over
519 m_control->Refresh();
520 }
521
522 void wxGridCellEditor::Destroy()
523 {
524 if (m_control)
525 {
526 m_control->PopEventHandler( true /* delete it*/ );
527
528 m_control->Destroy();
529 m_control = NULL;
530 }
531 }
532
533 void wxGridCellEditor::Show(bool show, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
534 {
535 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
536
537 m_control->Show(show);
538
539 if ( show )
540 {
541 // set the colours/fonts if we have any
542 if ( attr )
543 {
544 m_colFgOld = m_control->GetForegroundColour();
545 m_control->SetForegroundColour(attr->GetTextColour());
546
547 m_colBgOld = m_control->GetBackgroundColour();
548 m_control->SetBackgroundColour(attr->GetBackgroundColour());
549
550 // Workaround for GTK+1 font setting problem on some platforms
551 #if !defined(__WXGTK__) || defined(__WXGTK20__)
552 m_fontOld = m_control->GetFont();
553 m_control->SetFont(attr->GetFont());
554 #endif
555
556 // can't do anything more in the base class version, the other
557 // attributes may only be used by the derived classes
558 }
559 }
560 else
561 {
562 // restore the standard colours fonts
563 if ( m_colFgOld.Ok() )
564 {
565 m_control->SetForegroundColour(m_colFgOld);
566 m_colFgOld = wxNullColour;
567 }
568
569 if ( m_colBgOld.Ok() )
570 {
571 m_control->SetBackgroundColour(m_colBgOld);
572 m_colBgOld = wxNullColour;
573 }
574
575 // Workaround for GTK+1 font setting problem on some platforms
576 #if !defined(__WXGTK__) || defined(__WXGTK20__)
577 if ( m_fontOld.Ok() )
578 {
579 m_control->SetFont(m_fontOld);
580 m_fontOld = wxNullFont;
581 }
582 #endif
583 }
584 }
585
586 void wxGridCellEditor::SetSize(const wxRect& rect)
587 {
588 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
589
590 m_control->SetSize(rect, wxSIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE);
591 }
592
593 void wxGridCellEditor::HandleReturn(wxKeyEvent& event)
594 {
595 event.Skip();
596 }
597
598 bool wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
599 {
600 bool ctrl = event.ControlDown();
601 bool alt = event.AltDown();
602
603 #ifdef __WXMAC__
604 // On the Mac the Alt key is more like shift and is used for entry of
605 // valid characters, so check for Ctrl and Meta instead.
606 alt = event.MetaDown();
607 #endif
608
609 // Assume it's not a valid char if ctrl or alt is down, but if both are
610 // down then it may be because of an AltGr key combination, so let them
611 // through in that case.
612 if ((ctrl || alt) && !(ctrl && alt))
613 return false;
614
615 int key = 0;
616 bool keyOk = true;
617
618 #ifdef __WXGTK20__
619 // If it's a F-Key or other special key then it shouldn't start the
620 // editor.
621 if (event.GetKeyCode() >= WXK_START)
622 return false;
623 #endif
624 #if wxUSE_UNICODE
625 // if the unicode key code is not really a unicode character (it may
626 // be a function key or etc., the platforms appear to always give us a
627 // small value in this case) then fallback to the ASCII key code but
628 // don't do anything for function keys or etc.
629 key = event.GetUnicodeKey();
630 if (key <= 127)
631 {
632 key = event.GetKeyCode();
633 keyOk = (key <= 127);
634 }
635 #else
636 key = event.GetKeyCode();
637 keyOk = (key <= 255);
638 #endif
639
640 return keyOk;
641 }
642
643 void wxGridCellEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
644 {
645 event.Skip();
646 }
647
648 void wxGridCellEditor::StartingClick()
649 {
650 }
651
652 #if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
653
654 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
655 // wxGridCellTextEditor
656 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
657
658 wxGridCellTextEditor::wxGridCellTextEditor()
659 {
660 m_maxChars = 0;
661 }
662
663 void wxGridCellTextEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
664 wxWindowID id,
665 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
666 {
667 DoCreate(parent, id, evtHandler);
668 }
669
670 void wxGridCellTextEditor::DoCreate(wxWindow* parent,
671 wxWindowID id,
672 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler,
673 long style)
674 {
675 style |= wxTE_PROCESS_ENTER | wxTE_PROCESS_TAB | wxNO_BORDER;
676
677 m_control = new wxTextCtrl(parent, id, wxEmptyString,
678 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
679 style);
680
681 // set max length allowed in the textctrl, if the parameter was set
682 if ( m_maxChars != 0 )
683 {
684 Text()->SetMaxLength(m_maxChars);
685 }
686
687 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
688 }
689
690 void wxGridCellTextEditor::PaintBackground(const wxRect& WXUNUSED(rectCell),
691 wxGridCellAttr * WXUNUSED(attr))
692 {
693 // as we fill the entire client area,
694 // don't do anything here to minimize flicker
695 }
696
697 void wxGridCellTextEditor::SetSize(const wxRect& rectOrig)
698 {
699 wxRect rect(rectOrig);
700
701 // Make the edit control large enough to allow for internal margins
702 //
703 // TODO: remove this if the text ctrl sizing is improved esp. for unix
704 //
705 #if defined(__WXGTK__)
706 if (rect.x != 0)
707 {
708 rect.x += 1;
709 rect.y += 1;
710 rect.width -= 1;
711 rect.height -= 1;
712 }
713 #elif defined(__WXMSW__)
714 if ( rect.x == 0 )
715 rect.x += 2;
716 else
717 rect.x += 3;
718
719 if ( rect.y == 0 )
720 rect.y += 2;
721 else
722 rect.y += 3;
723
724 rect.width -= 2;
725 rect.height -= 2;
726 #else
727 int extra_x = ( rect.x > 2 ) ? 2 : 1;
728 int extra_y = ( rect.y > 2 ) ? 2 : 1;
729
730 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
731 extra_x *= 2;
732 extra_y *= 2;
733 #endif
734
735 rect.SetLeft( wxMax(0, rect.x - extra_x) );
736 rect.SetTop( wxMax(0, rect.y - extra_y) );
737 rect.SetRight( rect.GetRight() + 2 * extra_x );
738 rect.SetBottom( rect.GetBottom() + 2 * extra_y );
739 #endif
740
741 wxGridCellEditor::SetSize(rect);
742 }
743
744 void wxGridCellTextEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
745 {
746 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
747
748 m_startValue = grid->GetTable()->GetValue(row, col);
749
750 DoBeginEdit(m_startValue);
751 }
752
753 void wxGridCellTextEditor::DoBeginEdit(const wxString& startValue)
754 {
755 Text()->SetValue(startValue);
756 Text()->SetInsertionPointEnd();
757 Text()->SetSelection(-1, -1);
758 Text()->SetFocus();
759 }
760
761 bool wxGridCellTextEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
762 {
763 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
764
765 bool changed = false;
766 wxString value = Text()->GetValue();
767 if (value != m_startValue)
768 changed = true;
769
770 if (changed)
771 grid->GetTable()->SetValue(row, col, value);
772
773 m_startValue = wxEmptyString;
774
775 // No point in setting the text of the hidden control
776 //Text()->SetValue(m_startValue);
777
778 return changed;
779 }
780
781 void wxGridCellTextEditor::Reset()
782 {
783 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control, wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
784
785 DoReset(m_startValue);
786 }
787
788 void wxGridCellTextEditor::DoReset(const wxString& startValue)
789 {
790 Text()->SetValue(startValue);
791 Text()->SetInsertionPointEnd();
792 }
793
794 bool wxGridCellTextEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
795 {
796 return wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event);
797 }
798
799 void wxGridCellTextEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
800 {
801 // Since this is now happening in the EVT_CHAR event EmulateKeyPress is no
802 // longer an appropriate way to get the character into the text control.
803 // Do it ourselves instead. We know that if we get this far that we have
804 // a valid character, so not a whole lot of testing needs to be done.
805
806 wxTextCtrl* tc = Text();
807 wxChar ch;
808 long pos;
809
810 #if wxUSE_UNICODE
811 ch = event.GetUnicodeKey();
812 if (ch <= 127)
813 ch = (wxChar)event.GetKeyCode();
814 #else
815 ch = (wxChar)event.GetKeyCode();
816 #endif
817
818 switch (ch)
819 {
820 case WXK_DELETE:
821 // delete the character at the cursor
822 pos = tc->GetInsertionPoint();
823 if (pos < tc->GetLastPosition())
824 tc->Remove(pos, pos + 1);
825 break;
826
827 case WXK_BACK:
828 // delete the character before the cursor
829 pos = tc->GetInsertionPoint();
830 if (pos > 0)
831 tc->Remove(pos - 1, pos);
832 break;
833
834 default:
835 tc->WriteText(ch);
836 break;
837 }
838 }
839
840 void wxGridCellTextEditor::HandleReturn( wxKeyEvent&
841 WXUNUSED_GTK(WXUNUSED_MOTIF(event)) )
842 {
843 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__) || defined(__WXGTK__)
844 // wxMotif needs a little extra help...
845 size_t pos = (size_t)( Text()->GetInsertionPoint() );
846 wxString s( Text()->GetValue() );
847 s = s.Left(pos) + wxT("\n") + s.Mid(pos);
848 Text()->SetValue(s);
849 Text()->SetInsertionPoint( pos );
850 #else
851 // the other ports can handle a Return key press
852 //
853 event.Skip();
854 #endif
855 }
856
857 void wxGridCellTextEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
858 {
859 if ( !params )
860 {
861 // reset to default
862 m_maxChars = 0;
863 }
864 else
865 {
866 long tmp;
867 if ( params.ToLong(&tmp) )
868 {
869 m_maxChars = (size_t)tmp;
870 }
871 else
872 {
873 wxLogDebug( _T("Invalid wxGridCellTextEditor parameter string '%s' ignored"), params.c_str() );
874 }
875 }
876 }
877
878 // return the value in the text control
879 wxString wxGridCellTextEditor::GetValue() const
880 {
881 return Text()->GetValue();
882 }
883
884 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
885 // wxGridCellNumberEditor
886 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
887
888 wxGridCellNumberEditor::wxGridCellNumberEditor(int min, int max)
889 {
890 m_min = min;
891 m_max = max;
892 }
893
894 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
895 wxWindowID id,
896 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
897 {
898 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
899 if ( HasRange() )
900 {
901 // create a spin ctrl
902 m_control = new wxSpinCtrl(parent, wxID_ANY, wxEmptyString,
903 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
904 wxSP_ARROW_KEYS,
905 m_min, m_max);
906
907 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
908 }
909 else
910 #endif
911 {
912 // just a text control
913 wxGridCellTextEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
914
915 #if wxUSE_VALIDATORS
916 Text()->SetValidator(wxTextValidator(wxFILTER_NUMERIC));
917 #endif
918 }
919 }
920
921 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
922 {
923 // first get the value
924 wxGridTableBase *table = grid->GetTable();
925 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER) )
926 {
927 m_valueOld = table->GetValueAsLong(row, col);
928 }
929 else
930 {
931 m_valueOld = 0;
932 wxString sValue = table->GetValue(row, col);
933 if (! sValue.ToLong(&m_valueOld) && ! sValue.empty())
934 {
935 wxFAIL_MSG( _T("this cell doesn't have numeric value") );
936 return;
937 }
938 }
939
940 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
941 if ( HasRange() )
942 {
943 Spin()->SetValue((int)m_valueOld);
944 Spin()->SetFocus();
945 }
946 else
947 #endif
948 {
949 DoBeginEdit(GetString());
950 }
951 }
952
953 bool wxGridCellNumberEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col,
954 wxGrid* grid)
955 {
956 long value = 0;
957 wxString text;
958
959 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
960 if ( HasRange() )
961 {
962 value = Spin()->GetValue();
963 if ( value == m_valueOld )
964 return false;
965
966 text.Printf(wxT("%ld"), value);
967 }
968 else // using unconstrained input
969 #endif // wxUSE_SPINCTRL
970 {
971 const wxString textOld(grid->GetCellValue(row, col));
972 text = Text()->GetValue();
973 if ( text.empty() )
974 {
975 if ( textOld.empty() )
976 return false;
977 }
978 else // non-empty text now (maybe 0)
979 {
980 if ( !text.ToLong(&value) )
981 return false;
982
983 // if value == m_valueOld == 0 but old text was "" and new one is
984 // "0" something still did change
985 if ( value == m_valueOld && (value || !textOld.empty()) )
986 return false;
987 }
988 }
989
990 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
991 if ( table->CanSetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER) )
992 table->SetValueAsLong(row, col, value);
993 else
994 table->SetValue(row, col, text);
995
996 return true;
997 }
998
999 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::Reset()
1000 {
1001 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1002 if ( HasRange() )
1003 {
1004 Spin()->SetValue((int)m_valueOld);
1005 }
1006 else
1007 #endif
1008 {
1009 DoReset(GetString());
1010 }
1011 }
1012
1013 bool wxGridCellNumberEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1014 {
1015 if ( wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event) )
1016 {
1017 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1018 if ( (keycode < 128) &&
1019 (wxIsdigit(keycode) || keycode == '+' || keycode == '-'))
1020 {
1021 return true;
1022 }
1023 }
1024
1025 return false;
1026 }
1027
1028 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1029 {
1030 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1031 if ( !HasRange() )
1032 {
1033 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) || keycode == '+' || keycode == '-')
1034 {
1035 wxGridCellTextEditor::StartingKey(event);
1036
1037 // skip Skip() below
1038 return;
1039 }
1040 }
1041 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1042 else
1043 {
1044 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) )
1045 {
1046 wxSpinCtrl* spin = (wxSpinCtrl*)m_control;
1047 spin->SetValue(keycode - '0');
1048 spin->SetSelection(1,1);
1049 return;
1050 }
1051 }
1052 #endif
1053
1054 event.Skip();
1055 }
1056
1057 void wxGridCellNumberEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1058 {
1059 if ( !params )
1060 {
1061 // reset to default
1062 m_min =
1063 m_max = -1;
1064 }
1065 else
1066 {
1067 long tmp;
1068 if ( params.BeforeFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1069 {
1070 m_min = (int)tmp;
1071
1072 if ( params.AfterFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1073 {
1074 m_max = (int)tmp;
1075
1076 // skip the error message below
1077 return;
1078 }
1079 }
1080
1081 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellNumberEditor parameter string '%s' ignored"), params.c_str());
1082 }
1083 }
1084
1085 // return the value in the spin control if it is there (the text control otherwise)
1086 wxString wxGridCellNumberEditor::GetValue() const
1087 {
1088 wxString s;
1089
1090 #if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
1091 if ( HasRange() )
1092 {
1093 long value = Spin()->GetValue();
1094 s.Printf(wxT("%ld"), value);
1095 }
1096 else
1097 #endif
1098 {
1099 s = Text()->GetValue();
1100 }
1101
1102 return s;
1103 }
1104
1105 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1106 // wxGridCellFloatEditor
1107 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1108
1109 wxGridCellFloatEditor::wxGridCellFloatEditor(int width, int precision)
1110 {
1111 m_width = width;
1112 m_precision = precision;
1113 }
1114
1115 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1116 wxWindowID id,
1117 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1118 {
1119 wxGridCellTextEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1120
1121 #if wxUSE_VALIDATORS
1122 Text()->SetValidator(wxTextValidator(wxFILTER_NUMERIC));
1123 #endif
1124 }
1125
1126 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1127 {
1128 // first get the value
1129 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1130 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT) )
1131 {
1132 m_valueOld = table->GetValueAsDouble(row, col);
1133 }
1134 else
1135 {
1136 m_valueOld = 0.0;
1137
1138 const wxString value = table->GetValue(row, col);
1139 if ( !value.empty() )
1140 {
1141 if ( !value.ToDouble(&m_valueOld) )
1142 {
1143 wxFAIL_MSG( _T("this cell doesn't have float value") );
1144 return;
1145 }
1146 }
1147 }
1148
1149 DoBeginEdit(GetString());
1150 }
1151
1152 bool wxGridCellFloatEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1153 {
1154 const wxString text(Text()->GetValue()),
1155 textOld(grid->GetCellValue(row, col));
1156
1157 double value;
1158 if ( !text.empty() )
1159 {
1160 if ( !text.ToDouble(&value) )
1161 return false;
1162 }
1163 else // new value is empty string
1164 {
1165 if ( textOld.empty() )
1166 return false; // nothing changed
1167
1168 value = 0.;
1169 }
1170
1171 // the test for empty strings ensures that we don't skip the value setting
1172 // when "" is replaced by "0" or vice versa as "" numeric value is also 0.
1173 if ( wxIsSameDouble(value, m_valueOld) && !text.empty() && !textOld.empty() )
1174 return false; // nothing changed
1175
1176 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1177
1178 if ( table->CanSetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT) )
1179 table->SetValueAsDouble(row, col, value);
1180 else
1181 table->SetValue(row, col, text);
1182
1183 return true;
1184 }
1185
1186 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::Reset()
1187 {
1188 DoReset(GetString());
1189 }
1190
1191 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1192 {
1193 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1194 char tmpbuf[2];
1195 tmpbuf[0] = (char) keycode;
1196 tmpbuf[1] = '\0';
1197 wxString strbuf(tmpbuf, *wxConvCurrent);
1198
1199 #if wxUSE_INTL
1200 bool is_decimal_point = ( strbuf ==
1201 wxLocale::GetInfo(wxLOCALE_DECIMAL_POINT, wxLOCALE_CAT_NUMBER) );
1202 #else
1203 bool is_decimal_point = ( strbuf == _T(".") );
1204 #endif
1205
1206 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) || keycode == '+' || keycode == '-'
1207 || is_decimal_point )
1208 {
1209 wxGridCellTextEditor::StartingKey(event);
1210
1211 // skip Skip() below
1212 return;
1213 }
1214
1215 event.Skip();
1216 }
1217
1218 void wxGridCellFloatEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1219 {
1220 if ( !params )
1221 {
1222 // reset to default
1223 m_width =
1224 m_precision = -1;
1225 }
1226 else
1227 {
1228 long tmp;
1229 if ( params.BeforeFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1230 {
1231 m_width = (int)tmp;
1232
1233 if ( params.AfterFirst(_T(',')).ToLong(&tmp) )
1234 {
1235 m_precision = (int)tmp;
1236
1237 // skip the error message below
1238 return;
1239 }
1240 }
1241
1242 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellFloatEditor parameter string '%s' ignored"), params.c_str());
1243 }
1244 }
1245
1246 wxString wxGridCellFloatEditor::GetString() const
1247 {
1248 wxString fmt;
1249 if ( m_precision == -1 && m_width != -1)
1250 {
1251 // default precision
1252 fmt.Printf(_T("%%%d.f"), m_width);
1253 }
1254 else if ( m_precision != -1 && m_width == -1)
1255 {
1256 // default width
1257 fmt.Printf(_T("%%.%df"), m_precision);
1258 }
1259 else if ( m_precision != -1 && m_width != -1 )
1260 {
1261 fmt.Printf(_T("%%%d.%df"), m_width, m_precision);
1262 }
1263 else
1264 {
1265 // default width/precision
1266 fmt = _T("%f");
1267 }
1268
1269 return wxString::Format(fmt, m_valueOld);
1270 }
1271
1272 bool wxGridCellFloatEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1273 {
1274 if ( wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event) )
1275 {
1276 const int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1277 if ( isascii(keycode) )
1278 {
1279 char tmpbuf[2];
1280 tmpbuf[0] = (char) keycode;
1281 tmpbuf[1] = '\0';
1282 wxString strbuf(tmpbuf, *wxConvCurrent);
1283
1284 #if wxUSE_INTL
1285 const wxString decimalPoint =
1286 wxLocale::GetInfo(wxLOCALE_DECIMAL_POINT, wxLOCALE_CAT_NUMBER);
1287 #else
1288 const wxString decimalPoint(_T('.'));
1289 #endif
1290
1291 // accept digits, 'e' as in '1e+6', also '-', '+', and '.'
1292 if ( wxIsdigit(keycode) ||
1293 tolower(keycode) == 'e' ||
1294 keycode == decimalPoint ||
1295 keycode == '+' ||
1296 keycode == '-' )
1297 {
1298 return true;
1299 }
1300 }
1301 }
1302
1303 return false;
1304 }
1305
1306 #endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
1307
1308 #if wxUSE_CHECKBOX
1309
1310 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1311 // wxGridCellBoolEditor
1312 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1313
1314 // the default values for GetValue()
1315 wxString wxGridCellBoolEditor::ms_stringValues[2] = { _T(""), _T("1") };
1316
1317 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1318 wxWindowID id,
1319 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1320 {
1321 m_control = new wxCheckBox(parent, id, wxEmptyString,
1322 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
1323 wxNO_BORDER);
1324
1325 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1326 }
1327
1328 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::SetSize(const wxRect& r)
1329 {
1330 bool resize = false;
1331 wxSize size = m_control->GetSize();
1332 wxCoord minSize = wxMin(r.width, r.height);
1333
1334 // check if the checkbox is not too big/small for this cell
1335 wxSize sizeBest = m_control->GetBestSize();
1336 if ( !(size == sizeBest) )
1337 {
1338 // reset to default size if it had been made smaller
1339 size = sizeBest;
1340
1341 resize = true;
1342 }
1343
1344 if ( size.x >= minSize || size.y >= minSize )
1345 {
1346 // leave 1 pixel margin
1347 size.x = size.y = minSize - 2;
1348
1349 resize = true;
1350 }
1351
1352 if ( resize )
1353 {
1354 m_control->SetSize(size);
1355 }
1356
1357 // position it in the centre of the rectangle (TODO: support alignment?)
1358
1359 #if defined(__WXGTK__) || defined (__WXMOTIF__)
1360 // the checkbox without label still has some space to the right in wxGTK,
1361 // so shift it to the right
1362 size.x -= 8;
1363 #elif defined(__WXMSW__)
1364 // here too, but in other way
1365 size.x += 1;
1366 size.y -= 2;
1367 #endif
1368
1369 int hAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
1370 int vAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
1371 if (GetCellAttr())
1372 GetCellAttr()->GetAlignment(& hAlign, & vAlign);
1373
1374 int x = 0, y = 0;
1375 if (hAlign == wxALIGN_LEFT)
1376 {
1377 x = r.x + 2;
1378
1379 #ifdef __WXMSW__
1380 x += 2;
1381 #endif
1382
1383 y = r.y + r.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
1384 }
1385 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_RIGHT)
1386 {
1387 x = r.x + r.width - size.x - 2;
1388 y = r.y + r.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
1389 }
1390 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_CENTRE)
1391 {
1392 x = r.x + r.width / 2 - size.x / 2;
1393 y = r.y + r.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
1394 }
1395
1396 m_control->Move(x, y);
1397 }
1398
1399 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::Show(bool show, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
1400 {
1401 m_control->Show(show);
1402
1403 if ( show )
1404 {
1405 wxColour colBg = attr ? attr->GetBackgroundColour() : *wxLIGHT_GREY;
1406 CBox()->SetBackgroundColour(colBg);
1407 }
1408 }
1409
1410 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1411 {
1412 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1413 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1414
1415 if (grid->GetTable()->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL))
1416 {
1417 m_startValue = grid->GetTable()->GetValueAsBool(row, col);
1418 }
1419 else
1420 {
1421 wxString cellval( grid->GetTable()->GetValue(row, col) );
1422
1423 if ( cellval == ms_stringValues[false] )
1424 m_startValue = false;
1425 else if ( cellval == ms_stringValues[true] )
1426 m_startValue = true;
1427 else
1428 {
1429 // do not try to be smart here and convert it to true or false
1430 // because we'll still overwrite it with something different and
1431 // this risks to be very surprising for the user code, let them
1432 // know about it
1433 wxFAIL_MSG( _T("invalid value for a cell with bool editor!") );
1434 }
1435 }
1436
1437 CBox()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1438 CBox()->SetFocus();
1439 }
1440
1441 bool wxGridCellBoolEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col,
1442 wxGrid* grid)
1443 {
1444 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1445 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1446
1447 bool changed = false;
1448 bool value = CBox()->GetValue();
1449 if ( value != m_startValue )
1450 changed = true;
1451
1452 if ( changed )
1453 {
1454 wxGridTableBase * const table = grid->GetTable();
1455 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL) )
1456 table->SetValueAsBool(row, col, value);
1457 else
1458 table->SetValue(row, col, GetValue());
1459 }
1460
1461 return changed;
1462 }
1463
1464 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::Reset()
1465 {
1466 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1467 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1468
1469 CBox()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1470 }
1471
1472 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::StartingClick()
1473 {
1474 CBox()->SetValue(!CBox()->GetValue());
1475 }
1476
1477 bool wxGridCellBoolEditor::IsAcceptedKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1478 {
1479 if ( wxGridCellEditor::IsAcceptedKey(event) )
1480 {
1481 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1482 switch ( keycode )
1483 {
1484 case WXK_SPACE:
1485 case '+':
1486 case '-':
1487 return true;
1488 }
1489 }
1490
1491 return false;
1492 }
1493
1494 void wxGridCellBoolEditor::StartingKey(wxKeyEvent& event)
1495 {
1496 int keycode = event.GetKeyCode();
1497 switch ( keycode )
1498 {
1499 case WXK_SPACE:
1500 CBox()->SetValue(!CBox()->GetValue());
1501 break;
1502
1503 case '+':
1504 CBox()->SetValue(true);
1505 break;
1506
1507 case '-':
1508 CBox()->SetValue(false);
1509 break;
1510 }
1511 }
1512
1513 wxString wxGridCellBoolEditor::GetValue() const
1514 {
1515 return ms_stringValues[CBox()->GetValue()];
1516 }
1517
1518 /* static */ void
1519 wxGridCellBoolEditor::UseStringValues(const wxString& valueTrue,
1520 const wxString& valueFalse)
1521 {
1522 ms_stringValues[false] = valueFalse;
1523 ms_stringValues[true] = valueTrue;
1524 }
1525
1526 /* static */ bool
1527 wxGridCellBoolEditor::IsTrueValue(const wxString& value)
1528 {
1529 return value == ms_stringValues[true];
1530 }
1531
1532 #endif // wxUSE_CHECKBOX
1533
1534 #if wxUSE_COMBOBOX
1535
1536 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1537 // wxGridCellChoiceEditor
1538 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1539
1540 wxGridCellChoiceEditor::wxGridCellChoiceEditor(const wxArrayString& choices,
1541 bool allowOthers)
1542 : m_choices(choices),
1543 m_allowOthers(allowOthers) { }
1544
1545 wxGridCellChoiceEditor::wxGridCellChoiceEditor(size_t count,
1546 const wxString choices[],
1547 bool allowOthers)
1548 : m_allowOthers(allowOthers)
1549 {
1550 if ( count )
1551 {
1552 m_choices.Alloc(count);
1553 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
1554 {
1555 m_choices.Add(choices[n]);
1556 }
1557 }
1558 }
1559
1560 wxGridCellEditor *wxGridCellChoiceEditor::Clone() const
1561 {
1562 wxGridCellChoiceEditor *editor = new wxGridCellChoiceEditor;
1563 editor->m_allowOthers = m_allowOthers;
1564 editor->m_choices = m_choices;
1565
1566 return editor;
1567 }
1568
1569 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::Create(wxWindow* parent,
1570 wxWindowID id,
1571 wxEvtHandler* evtHandler)
1572 {
1573 int style = wxTE_PROCESS_ENTER |
1574 wxTE_PROCESS_TAB |
1575 wxBORDER_NONE;
1576
1577 if ( !m_allowOthers )
1578 style |= wxCB_READONLY;
1579 m_control = new wxComboBox(parent, id, wxEmptyString,
1580 wxDefaultPosition, wxDefaultSize,
1581 m_choices,
1582 style);
1583
1584 wxGridCellEditor::Create(parent, id, evtHandler);
1585 }
1586
1587 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::PaintBackground(const wxRect& rectCell,
1588 wxGridCellAttr * attr)
1589 {
1590 // as we fill the entire client area, don't do anything here to minimize
1591 // flicker
1592
1593 // TODO: It doesn't actually fill the client area since the height of a
1594 // combo always defaults to the standard. Until someone has time to
1595 // figure out the right rectangle to paint, just do it the normal way.
1596 wxGridCellEditor::PaintBackground(rectCell, attr);
1597 }
1598
1599 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::BeginEdit(int row, int col, wxGrid* grid)
1600 {
1601 wxASSERT_MSG(m_control,
1602 wxT("The wxGridCellEditor must be created first!"));
1603
1604 wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler* evtHandler = NULL;
1605 if (m_control)
1606 evtHandler = wxDynamicCast(m_control->GetEventHandler(), wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler);
1607
1608 // Don't immediately end if we get a kill focus event within BeginEdit
1609 if (evtHandler)
1610 evtHandler->SetInSetFocus(true);
1611
1612 m_startValue = grid->GetTable()->GetValue(row, col);
1613
1614 Reset(); // this updates combo box to correspond to m_startValue
1615
1616 Combo()->SetFocus();
1617
1618 if (evtHandler)
1619 {
1620 // When dropping down the menu, a kill focus event
1621 // happens after this point, so we can't reset the flag yet.
1622 #if !defined(__WXGTK20__)
1623 evtHandler->SetInSetFocus(false);
1624 #endif
1625 }
1626 }
1627
1628 bool wxGridCellChoiceEditor::EndEdit(int row, int col,
1629 wxGrid* grid)
1630 {
1631 wxString value = Combo()->GetValue();
1632 if ( value == m_startValue )
1633 return false;
1634
1635 grid->GetTable()->SetValue(row, col, value);
1636
1637 return true;
1638 }
1639
1640 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::Reset()
1641 {
1642 if (m_allowOthers)
1643 {
1644 Combo()->SetValue(m_startValue);
1645 Combo()->SetInsertionPointEnd();
1646 }
1647 else // the combobox is read-only
1648 {
1649 // find the right position, or default to the first if not found
1650 int pos = Combo()->FindString(m_startValue);
1651 if (pos == wxNOT_FOUND)
1652 pos = 0;
1653 Combo()->SetSelection(pos);
1654 }
1655 }
1656
1657 void wxGridCellChoiceEditor::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
1658 {
1659 if ( !params )
1660 {
1661 // what can we do?
1662 return;
1663 }
1664
1665 m_choices.Empty();
1666
1667 wxStringTokenizer tk(params, _T(','));
1668 while ( tk.HasMoreTokens() )
1669 {
1670 m_choices.Add(tk.GetNextToken());
1671 }
1672 }
1673
1674 // return the value in the text control
1675 wxString wxGridCellChoiceEditor::GetValue() const
1676 {
1677 return Combo()->GetValue();
1678 }
1679
1680 #endif // wxUSE_COMBOBOX
1681
1682 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1683 // wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler
1684 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1685
1686 void wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKillFocus(wxFocusEvent& event)
1687 {
1688 // Don't disable the cell if we're just starting to edit it
1689 if (m_inSetFocus)
1690 return;
1691
1692 // accept changes
1693 m_grid->DisableCellEditControl();
1694
1695 event.Skip();
1696 }
1697
1698 void wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnKeyDown(wxKeyEvent& event)
1699 {
1700 switch ( event.GetKeyCode() )
1701 {
1702 case WXK_ESCAPE:
1703 m_editor->Reset();
1704 m_grid->DisableCellEditControl();
1705 break;
1706
1707 case WXK_TAB:
1708 m_grid->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event );
1709 break;
1710
1711 case WXK_RETURN:
1712 case WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER:
1713 if (!m_grid->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event))
1714 m_editor->HandleReturn(event);
1715 break;
1716
1717 default:
1718 event.Skip();
1719 break;
1720 }
1721 }
1722
1723 void wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler::OnChar(wxKeyEvent& event)
1724 {
1725 int row = m_grid->GetGridCursorRow();
1726 int col = m_grid->GetGridCursorCol();
1727 wxRect rect = m_grid->CellToRect( row, col );
1728 int cw, ch;
1729 m_grid->GetGridWindow()->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
1730
1731 // if cell width is smaller than grid client area, cell is wholly visible
1732 bool wholeCellVisible = (rect.GetWidth() < cw);
1733
1734 switch ( event.GetKeyCode() )
1735 {
1736 case WXK_ESCAPE:
1737 case WXK_TAB:
1738 case WXK_RETURN:
1739 case WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER:
1740 break;
1741
1742 case WXK_HOME:
1743 {
1744 if ( wholeCellVisible )
1745 {
1746 // no special processing needed...
1747 event.Skip();
1748 break;
1749 }
1750
1751 // do special processing for partly visible cell...
1752
1753 // get the widths of all cells previous to this one
1754 int colXPos = 0;
1755 for ( int i = 0; i < col; i++ )
1756 {
1757 colXPos += m_grid->GetColSize(i);
1758 }
1759
1760 int xUnit = 1, yUnit = 1;
1761 m_grid->GetScrollPixelsPerUnit(&xUnit, &yUnit);
1762 if (col != 0)
1763 {
1764 m_grid->Scroll(colXPos / xUnit - 1, m_grid->GetScrollPos(wxVERTICAL));
1765 }
1766 else
1767 {
1768 m_grid->Scroll(colXPos / xUnit, m_grid->GetScrollPos(wxVERTICAL));
1769 }
1770 event.Skip();
1771 break;
1772 }
1773
1774 case WXK_END:
1775 {
1776 if ( wholeCellVisible )
1777 {
1778 // no special processing needed...
1779 event.Skip();
1780 break;
1781 }
1782
1783 // do special processing for partly visible cell...
1784
1785 int textWidth = 0;
1786 wxString value = m_grid->GetCellValue(row, col);
1787 if ( wxEmptyString != value )
1788 {
1789 // get width of cell CONTENTS (text)
1790 int y;
1791 wxFont font = m_grid->GetCellFont(row, col);
1792 m_grid->GetTextExtent(value, &textWidth, &y, NULL, NULL, &font);
1793
1794 // try to RIGHT align the text by scrolling
1795 int client_right = m_grid->GetGridWindow()->GetClientSize().GetWidth();
1796
1797 // (m_grid->GetScrollLineX()*2) is a factor for not scrolling to far,
1798 // otherwise the last part of the cell content might be hidden below the scroll bar
1799 // FIXME: maybe there is a more suitable correction?
1800 textWidth -= (client_right - (m_grid->GetScrollLineX() * 2));
1801 if ( textWidth < 0 )
1802 {
1803 textWidth = 0;
1804 }
1805 }
1806
1807 // get the widths of all cells previous to this one
1808 int colXPos = 0;
1809 for ( int i = 0; i < col; i++ )
1810 {
1811 colXPos += m_grid->GetColSize(i);
1812 }
1813
1814 // and add the (modified) text width of the cell contents
1815 // as we'd like to see the last part of the cell contents
1816 colXPos += textWidth;
1817
1818 int xUnit = 1, yUnit = 1;
1819 m_grid->GetScrollPixelsPerUnit(&xUnit, &yUnit);
1820 m_grid->Scroll(colXPos / xUnit - 1, m_grid->GetScrollPos(wxVERTICAL));
1821 event.Skip();
1822 break;
1823 }
1824
1825 default:
1826 event.Skip();
1827 break;
1828 }
1829 }
1830
1831 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1832 // wxGridCellWorker is an (almost) empty common base class for
1833 // wxGridCellRenderer and wxGridCellEditor managing ref counting
1834 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1835
1836 void wxGridCellWorker::SetParameters(const wxString& WXUNUSED(params))
1837 {
1838 // nothing to do
1839 }
1840
1841 wxGridCellWorker::~wxGridCellWorker()
1842 {
1843 }
1844
1845 // ============================================================================
1846 // renderer classes
1847 // ============================================================================
1848
1849 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1850 // wxGridCellRenderer
1851 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1852
1853 void wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
1854 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
1855 wxDC& dc,
1856 const wxRect& rect,
1857 int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
1858 bool isSelected)
1859 {
1860 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID );
1861
1862 // grey out fields if the grid is disabled
1863 if ( grid.IsEnabled() )
1864 {
1865 if ( isSelected )
1866 {
1867 wxColour clr;
1868 if ( grid.HasFocus() )
1869 clr = grid.GetSelectionBackground();
1870 else
1871 clr = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNSHADOW);
1872 dc.SetBrush( wxBrush(clr, wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID) );
1873 }
1874 else
1875 {
1876 dc.SetBrush( wxBrush(attr.GetBackgroundColour(), wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID) );
1877 }
1878 }
1879 else
1880 {
1881 dc.SetBrush(wxBrush(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNFACE), wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID));
1882 }
1883
1884 dc.SetPen( *wxTRANSPARENT_PEN );
1885 dc.DrawRectangle(rect);
1886 }
1887
1888 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1889 // wxGridCellStringRenderer
1890 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1891
1892 void wxGridCellStringRenderer::SetTextColoursAndFont(const wxGrid& grid,
1893 const wxGridCellAttr& attr,
1894 wxDC& dc,
1895 bool isSelected)
1896 {
1897 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT );
1898
1899 // TODO some special colours for attr.IsReadOnly() case?
1900
1901 // different coloured text when the grid is disabled
1902 if ( grid.IsEnabled() )
1903 {
1904 if ( isSelected )
1905 {
1906 wxColour clr;
1907 if ( grid.HasFocus() )
1908 clr = grid.GetSelectionBackground();
1909 else
1910 clr = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNSHADOW);
1911 dc.SetTextBackground( clr );
1912 dc.SetTextForeground( grid.GetSelectionForeground() );
1913 }
1914 else
1915 {
1916 dc.SetTextBackground( attr.GetBackgroundColour() );
1917 dc.SetTextForeground( attr.GetTextColour() );
1918 }
1919 }
1920 else
1921 {
1922 dc.SetTextBackground(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNFACE));
1923 dc.SetTextForeground(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_GRAYTEXT));
1924 }
1925
1926 dc.SetFont( attr.GetFont() );
1927 }
1928
1929 wxSize wxGridCellStringRenderer::DoGetBestSize(const wxGridCellAttr& attr,
1930 wxDC& dc,
1931 const wxString& text)
1932 {
1933 wxCoord x = 0, y = 0, max_x = 0;
1934 dc.SetFont(attr.GetFont());
1935 wxStringTokenizer tk(text, _T('\n'));
1936 while ( tk.HasMoreTokens() )
1937 {
1938 dc.GetTextExtent(tk.GetNextToken(), &x, &y);
1939 max_x = wxMax(max_x, x);
1940 }
1941
1942 y *= 1 + text.Freq(wxT('\n')); // multiply by the number of lines.
1943
1944 return wxSize(max_x, y);
1945 }
1946
1947 wxSize wxGridCellStringRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
1948 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
1949 wxDC& dc,
1950 int row, int col)
1951 {
1952 return DoGetBestSize(attr, dc, grid.GetCellValue(row, col));
1953 }
1954
1955 void wxGridCellStringRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
1956 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
1957 wxDC& dc,
1958 const wxRect& rectCell,
1959 int row, int col,
1960 bool isSelected)
1961 {
1962 wxRect rect = rectCell;
1963 rect.Inflate(-1);
1964
1965 // erase only this cells background, overflow cells should have been erased
1966 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rectCell, row, col, isSelected);
1967
1968 int hAlign, vAlign;
1969 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
1970
1971 int overflowCols = 0;
1972
1973 if (attr.GetOverflow())
1974 {
1975 int cols = grid.GetNumberCols();
1976 int best_width = GetBestSize(grid,attr,dc,row,col).GetWidth();
1977 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
1978 attr.GetSize( &cell_rows, &cell_cols ); // shouldn't get here if <= 0
1979 if ((best_width > rectCell.width) && (col < cols) && grid.GetTable())
1980 {
1981 int i, c_cols, c_rows;
1982 for (i = col+cell_cols; i < cols; i++)
1983 {
1984 bool is_empty = true;
1985 for (int j=row; j < row + cell_rows; j++)
1986 {
1987 // check w/ anchor cell for multicell block
1988 grid.GetCellSize(j, i, &c_rows, &c_cols);
1989 if (c_rows > 0)
1990 c_rows = 0;
1991 if (!grid.GetTable()->IsEmptyCell(j + c_rows, i))
1992 {
1993 is_empty = false;
1994 break;
1995 }
1996 }
1997
1998 if (is_empty)
1999 {
2000 rect.width += grid.GetColSize(i);
2001 }
2002 else
2003 {
2004 i--;
2005 break;
2006 }
2007
2008 if (rect.width >= best_width)
2009 break;
2010 }
2011
2012 overflowCols = i - col - cell_cols + 1;
2013 if (overflowCols >= cols)
2014 overflowCols = cols - 1;
2015 }
2016
2017 if (overflowCols > 0) // redraw overflow cells w/ proper hilight
2018 {
2019 hAlign = wxALIGN_LEFT; // if oveflowed then it's left aligned
2020 wxRect clip = rect;
2021 clip.x += rectCell.width;
2022 // draw each overflow cell individually
2023 int col_end = col + cell_cols + overflowCols;
2024 if (col_end >= grid.GetNumberCols())
2025 col_end = grid.GetNumberCols() - 1;
2026 for (int i = col + cell_cols; i <= col_end; i++)
2027 {
2028 clip.width = grid.GetColSize(i) - 1;
2029 dc.DestroyClippingRegion();
2030 dc.SetClippingRegion(clip);
2031
2032 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc,
2033 grid.IsInSelection(row,i));
2034
2035 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, grid.GetCellValue(row, col),
2036 rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2037 clip.x += grid.GetColSize(i) - 1;
2038 }
2039
2040 rect = rectCell;
2041 rect.Inflate(-1);
2042 rect.width++;
2043 dc.DestroyClippingRegion();
2044 }
2045 }
2046
2047 // now we only have to draw the text
2048 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc, isSelected);
2049
2050 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, grid.GetCellValue(row, col),
2051 rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2052 }
2053
2054 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2055 // wxGridCellNumberRenderer
2056 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2057
2058 wxString wxGridCellNumberRenderer::GetString(const wxGrid& grid, int row, int col)
2059 {
2060 wxGridTableBase *table = grid.GetTable();
2061 wxString text;
2062 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER) )
2063 {
2064 text.Printf(_T("%ld"), table->GetValueAsLong(row, col));
2065 }
2066 else
2067 {
2068 text = table->GetValue(row, col);
2069 }
2070
2071 return text;
2072 }
2073
2074 void wxGridCellNumberRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2075 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2076 wxDC& dc,
2077 const wxRect& rectCell,
2078 int row, int col,
2079 bool isSelected)
2080 {
2081 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rectCell, row, col, isSelected);
2082
2083 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc, isSelected);
2084
2085 // draw the text right aligned by default
2086 int hAlign, vAlign;
2087 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2088 hAlign = wxALIGN_RIGHT;
2089
2090 wxRect rect = rectCell;
2091 rect.Inflate(-1);
2092
2093 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, GetString(grid, row, col), rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2094 }
2095
2096 wxSize wxGridCellNumberRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2097 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2098 wxDC& dc,
2099 int row, int col)
2100 {
2101 return DoGetBestSize(attr, dc, GetString(grid, row, col));
2102 }
2103
2104 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2105 // wxGridCellFloatRenderer
2106 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2107
2108 wxGridCellFloatRenderer::wxGridCellFloatRenderer(int width, int precision)
2109 {
2110 SetWidth(width);
2111 SetPrecision(precision);
2112 }
2113
2114 wxGridCellRenderer *wxGridCellFloatRenderer::Clone() const
2115 {
2116 wxGridCellFloatRenderer *renderer = new wxGridCellFloatRenderer;
2117 renderer->m_width = m_width;
2118 renderer->m_precision = m_precision;
2119 renderer->m_format = m_format;
2120
2121 return renderer;
2122 }
2123
2124 wxString wxGridCellFloatRenderer::GetString(const wxGrid& grid, int row, int col)
2125 {
2126 wxGridTableBase *table = grid.GetTable();
2127
2128 bool hasDouble;
2129 double val;
2130 wxString text;
2131 if ( table->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT) )
2132 {
2133 val = table->GetValueAsDouble(row, col);
2134 hasDouble = true;
2135 }
2136 else
2137 {
2138 text = table->GetValue(row, col);
2139 hasDouble = text.ToDouble(&val);
2140 }
2141
2142 if ( hasDouble )
2143 {
2144 if ( !m_format )
2145 {
2146 if ( m_width == -1 )
2147 {
2148 if ( m_precision == -1 )
2149 {
2150 // default width/precision
2151 m_format = _T("%f");
2152 }
2153 else
2154 {
2155 m_format.Printf(_T("%%.%df"), m_precision);
2156 }
2157 }
2158 else if ( m_precision == -1 )
2159 {
2160 // default precision
2161 m_format.Printf(_T("%%%d.f"), m_width);
2162 }
2163 else
2164 {
2165 m_format.Printf(_T("%%%d.%df"), m_width, m_precision);
2166 }
2167 }
2168
2169 text.Printf(m_format, val);
2170
2171 }
2172 //else: text already contains the string
2173
2174 return text;
2175 }
2176
2177 void wxGridCellFloatRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2178 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2179 wxDC& dc,
2180 const wxRect& rectCell,
2181 int row, int col,
2182 bool isSelected)
2183 {
2184 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rectCell, row, col, isSelected);
2185
2186 SetTextColoursAndFont(grid, attr, dc, isSelected);
2187
2188 // draw the text right aligned by default
2189 int hAlign, vAlign;
2190 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2191 hAlign = wxALIGN_RIGHT;
2192
2193 wxRect rect = rectCell;
2194 rect.Inflate(-1);
2195
2196 grid.DrawTextRectangle(dc, GetString(grid, row, col), rect, hAlign, vAlign);
2197 }
2198
2199 wxSize wxGridCellFloatRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2200 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2201 wxDC& dc,
2202 int row, int col)
2203 {
2204 return DoGetBestSize(attr, dc, GetString(grid, row, col));
2205 }
2206
2207 void wxGridCellFloatRenderer::SetParameters(const wxString& params)
2208 {
2209 if ( !params )
2210 {
2211 // reset to defaults
2212 SetWidth(-1);
2213 SetPrecision(-1);
2214 }
2215 else
2216 {
2217 wxString tmp = params.BeforeFirst(_T(','));
2218 if ( !tmp.empty() )
2219 {
2220 long width;
2221 if ( tmp.ToLong(&width) )
2222 {
2223 SetWidth((int)width);
2224 }
2225 else
2226 {
2227 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellFloatRenderer width parameter string '%s ignored"), params.c_str());
2228 }
2229 }
2230
2231 tmp = params.AfterFirst(_T(','));
2232 if ( !tmp.empty() )
2233 {
2234 long precision;
2235 if ( tmp.ToLong(&precision) )
2236 {
2237 SetPrecision((int)precision);
2238 }
2239 else
2240 {
2241 wxLogDebug(_T("Invalid wxGridCellFloatRenderer precision parameter string '%s ignored"), params.c_str());
2242 }
2243 }
2244 }
2245 }
2246
2247 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2248 // wxGridCellBoolRenderer
2249 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2250
2251 wxSize wxGridCellBoolRenderer::ms_sizeCheckMark;
2252
2253 // FIXME these checkbox size calculations are really ugly...
2254
2255 // between checkmark and box
2256 static const wxCoord wxGRID_CHECKMARK_MARGIN = 2;
2257
2258 wxSize wxGridCellBoolRenderer::GetBestSize(wxGrid& grid,
2259 wxGridCellAttr& WXUNUSED(attr),
2260 wxDC& WXUNUSED(dc),
2261 int WXUNUSED(row),
2262 int WXUNUSED(col))
2263 {
2264 // compute it only once (no locks for MT safeness in GUI thread...)
2265 if ( !ms_sizeCheckMark.x )
2266 {
2267 // get checkbox size
2268 wxCheckBox *checkbox = new wxCheckBox(&grid, wxID_ANY, wxEmptyString);
2269 wxSize size = checkbox->GetBestSize();
2270 wxCoord checkSize = size.y + 2 * wxGRID_CHECKMARK_MARGIN;
2271
2272 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
2273 checkSize -= size.y / 2;
2274 #endif
2275
2276 delete checkbox;
2277
2278 ms_sizeCheckMark.x = ms_sizeCheckMark.y = checkSize;
2279 }
2280
2281 return ms_sizeCheckMark;
2282 }
2283
2284 void wxGridCellBoolRenderer::Draw(wxGrid& grid,
2285 wxGridCellAttr& attr,
2286 wxDC& dc,
2287 const wxRect& rect,
2288 int row, int col,
2289 bool isSelected)
2290 {
2291 wxGridCellRenderer::Draw(grid, attr, dc, rect, row, col, isSelected);
2292
2293 // draw a check mark in the centre (ignoring alignment - TODO)
2294 wxSize size = GetBestSize(grid, attr, dc, row, col);
2295
2296 // don't draw outside the cell
2297 wxCoord minSize = wxMin(rect.width, rect.height);
2298 if ( size.x >= minSize || size.y >= minSize )
2299 {
2300 // and even leave (at least) 1 pixel margin
2301 size.x = size.y = minSize;
2302 }
2303
2304 // draw a border around checkmark
2305 int vAlign, hAlign;
2306 attr.GetAlignment(&hAlign, &vAlign);
2307
2308 wxRect rectBorder;
2309 if (hAlign == wxALIGN_CENTRE)
2310 {
2311 rectBorder.x = rect.x + rect.width / 2 - size.x / 2;
2312 rectBorder.y = rect.y + rect.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
2313 rectBorder.width = size.x;
2314 rectBorder.height = size.y;
2315 }
2316 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_LEFT)
2317 {
2318 rectBorder.x = rect.x + 2;
2319 rectBorder.y = rect.y + rect.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
2320 rectBorder.width = size.x;
2321 rectBorder.height = size.y;
2322 }
2323 else if (hAlign == wxALIGN_RIGHT)
2324 {
2325 rectBorder.x = rect.x + rect.width - size.x - 2;
2326 rectBorder.y = rect.y + rect.height / 2 - size.y / 2;
2327 rectBorder.width = size.x;
2328 rectBorder.height = size.y;
2329 }
2330
2331 bool value;
2332 if ( grid.GetTable()->CanGetValueAs(row, col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL) )
2333 {
2334 value = grid.GetTable()->GetValueAsBool(row, col);
2335 }
2336 else
2337 {
2338 wxString cellval( grid.GetTable()->GetValue(row, col) );
2339 value = wxGridCellBoolEditor::IsTrueValue(cellval);
2340 }
2341
2342 int flags = 0;
2343 if (value)
2344 flags |= wxCONTROL_CHECKED;
2345
2346 wxRendererNative::Get().DrawCheckBox( &grid, dc, rectBorder, flags );
2347 }
2348
2349 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2350 // wxGridCellAttr
2351 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2352
2353 void wxGridCellAttr::Init(wxGridCellAttr *attrDefault)
2354 {
2355 m_nRef = 1;
2356
2357 m_isReadOnly = Unset;
2358
2359 m_renderer = NULL;
2360 m_editor = NULL;
2361
2362 m_attrkind = wxGridCellAttr::Cell;
2363
2364 m_sizeRows = m_sizeCols = 1;
2365 m_overflow = UnsetOverflow;
2366
2367 SetDefAttr(attrDefault);
2368 }
2369
2370 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridCellAttr::Clone() const
2371 {
2372 wxGridCellAttr *attr = new wxGridCellAttr(m_defGridAttr);
2373
2374 if ( HasTextColour() )
2375 attr->SetTextColour(GetTextColour());
2376 if ( HasBackgroundColour() )
2377 attr->SetBackgroundColour(GetBackgroundColour());
2378 if ( HasFont() )
2379 attr->SetFont(GetFont());
2380 if ( HasAlignment() )
2381 attr->SetAlignment(m_hAlign, m_vAlign);
2382
2383 attr->SetSize( m_sizeRows, m_sizeCols );
2384
2385 if ( m_renderer )
2386 {
2387 attr->SetRenderer(m_renderer);
2388 m_renderer->IncRef();
2389 }
2390 if ( m_editor )
2391 {
2392 attr->SetEditor(m_editor);
2393 m_editor->IncRef();
2394 }
2395
2396 if ( IsReadOnly() )
2397 attr->SetReadOnly();
2398
2399 attr->SetOverflow( m_overflow == Overflow );
2400 attr->SetKind( m_attrkind );
2401
2402 return attr;
2403 }
2404
2405 void wxGridCellAttr::MergeWith(wxGridCellAttr *mergefrom)
2406 {
2407 if ( !HasTextColour() && mergefrom->HasTextColour() )
2408 SetTextColour(mergefrom->GetTextColour());
2409 if ( !HasBackgroundColour() && mergefrom->HasBackgroundColour() )
2410 SetBackgroundColour(mergefrom->GetBackgroundColour());
2411 if ( !HasFont() && mergefrom->HasFont() )
2412 SetFont(mergefrom->GetFont());
2413 if ( !HasAlignment() && mergefrom->HasAlignment() )
2414 {
2415 int hAlign, vAlign;
2416 mergefrom->GetAlignment( &hAlign, &vAlign);
2417 SetAlignment(hAlign, vAlign);
2418 }
2419 if ( !HasSize() && mergefrom->HasSize() )
2420 mergefrom->GetSize( &m_sizeRows, &m_sizeCols );
2421
2422 // Directly access member functions as GetRender/Editor don't just return
2423 // m_renderer/m_editor
2424 //
2425 // Maybe add support for merge of Render and Editor?
2426 if (!HasRenderer() && mergefrom->HasRenderer() )
2427 {
2428 m_renderer = mergefrom->m_renderer;
2429 m_renderer->IncRef();
2430 }
2431 if ( !HasEditor() && mergefrom->HasEditor() )
2432 {
2433 m_editor = mergefrom->m_editor;
2434 m_editor->IncRef();
2435 }
2436 if ( !HasReadWriteMode() && mergefrom->HasReadWriteMode() )
2437 SetReadOnly(mergefrom->IsReadOnly());
2438
2439 if (!HasOverflowMode() && mergefrom->HasOverflowMode() )
2440 SetOverflow(mergefrom->GetOverflow());
2441
2442 SetDefAttr(mergefrom->m_defGridAttr);
2443 }
2444
2445 void wxGridCellAttr::SetSize(int num_rows, int num_cols)
2446 {
2447 // The size of a cell is normally 1,1
2448
2449 // If this cell is larger (2,2) then this is the top left cell
2450 // the other cells that will be covered (lower right cells) must be
2451 // set to negative or zero values such that
2452 // row + num_rows of the covered cell points to the larger cell (this cell)
2453 // same goes for the col + num_cols.
2454
2455 // Size of 0,0 is NOT valid, neither is <=0 and any positive value
2456
2457 wxASSERT_MSG( (!((num_rows > 0) && (num_cols <= 0)) ||
2458 !((num_rows <= 0) && (num_cols > 0)) ||
2459 !((num_rows == 0) && (num_cols == 0))),
2460 wxT("wxGridCellAttr::SetSize only takes two postive values or negative/zero values"));
2461
2462 m_sizeRows = num_rows;
2463 m_sizeCols = num_cols;
2464 }
2465
2466 const wxColour& wxGridCellAttr::GetTextColour() const
2467 {
2468 if (HasTextColour())
2469 {
2470 return m_colText;
2471 }
2472 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2473 {
2474 return m_defGridAttr->GetTextColour();
2475 }
2476 else
2477 {
2478 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2479 return wxNullColour;
2480 }
2481 }
2482
2483 const wxColour& wxGridCellAttr::GetBackgroundColour() const
2484 {
2485 if (HasBackgroundColour())
2486 {
2487 return m_colBack;
2488 }
2489 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2490 {
2491 return m_defGridAttr->GetBackgroundColour();
2492 }
2493 else
2494 {
2495 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2496 return wxNullColour;
2497 }
2498 }
2499
2500 const wxFont& wxGridCellAttr::GetFont() const
2501 {
2502 if (HasFont())
2503 {
2504 return m_font;
2505 }
2506 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2507 {
2508 return m_defGridAttr->GetFont();
2509 }
2510 else
2511 {
2512 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2513 return wxNullFont;
2514 }
2515 }
2516
2517 void wxGridCellAttr::GetAlignment(int *hAlign, int *vAlign) const
2518 {
2519 if (HasAlignment())
2520 {
2521 if ( hAlign )
2522 *hAlign = m_hAlign;
2523 if ( vAlign )
2524 *vAlign = m_vAlign;
2525 }
2526 else if (m_defGridAttr && m_defGridAttr != this)
2527 {
2528 m_defGridAttr->GetAlignment(hAlign, vAlign);
2529 }
2530 else
2531 {
2532 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Missing default cell attribute"));
2533 }
2534 }
2535
2536 void wxGridCellAttr::GetSize( int *num_rows, int *num_cols ) const
2537 {
2538 if ( num_rows )
2539 *num_rows = m_sizeRows;
2540 if ( num_cols )
2541 *num_cols = m_sizeCols;
2542 }
2543
2544 // GetRenderer and GetEditor use a slightly different decision path about
2545 // which attribute to use. If a non-default attr object has one then it is
2546 // used, otherwise the default editor or renderer is fetched from the grid and
2547 // used. It should be the default for the data type of the cell. If it is
2548 // NULL (because the table has a type that the grid does not have in its
2549 // registry), then the grid's default editor or renderer is used.
2550
2551 wxGridCellRenderer* wxGridCellAttr::GetRenderer(const wxGrid* grid, int row, int col) const
2552 {
2553 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = NULL;
2554
2555 if ( m_renderer && this != m_defGridAttr )
2556 {
2557 // use the cells renderer if it has one
2558 renderer = m_renderer;
2559 renderer->IncRef();
2560 }
2561 else // no non-default cell renderer
2562 {
2563 // get default renderer for the data type
2564 if ( grid )
2565 {
2566 // GetDefaultRendererForCell() will do IncRef() for us
2567 renderer = grid->GetDefaultRendererForCell(row, col);
2568 }
2569
2570 if ( renderer == NULL )
2571 {
2572 if ( (m_defGridAttr != NULL) && (m_defGridAttr != this) )
2573 {
2574 // if we still don't have one then use the grid default
2575 // (no need for IncRef() here neither)
2576 renderer = m_defGridAttr->GetRenderer(NULL, 0, 0);
2577 }
2578 else // default grid attr
2579 {
2580 // use m_renderer which we had decided not to use initially
2581 renderer = m_renderer;
2582 if ( renderer )
2583 renderer->IncRef();
2584 }
2585 }
2586 }
2587
2588 // we're supposed to always find something
2589 wxASSERT_MSG(renderer, wxT("Missing default cell renderer"));
2590
2591 return renderer;
2592 }
2593
2594 // same as above, except for s/renderer/editor/g
2595 wxGridCellEditor* wxGridCellAttr::GetEditor(const wxGrid* grid, int row, int col) const
2596 {
2597 wxGridCellEditor *editor = NULL;
2598
2599 if ( m_editor && this != m_defGridAttr )
2600 {
2601 // use the cells editor if it has one
2602 editor = m_editor;
2603 editor->IncRef();
2604 }
2605 else // no non default cell editor
2606 {
2607 // get default editor for the data type
2608 if ( grid )
2609 {
2610 // GetDefaultEditorForCell() will do IncRef() for us
2611 editor = grid->GetDefaultEditorForCell(row, col);
2612 }
2613
2614 if ( editor == NULL )
2615 {
2616 if ( (m_defGridAttr != NULL) && (m_defGridAttr != this) )
2617 {
2618 // if we still don't have one then use the grid default
2619 // (no need for IncRef() here neither)
2620 editor = m_defGridAttr->GetEditor(NULL, 0, 0);
2621 }
2622 else // default grid attr
2623 {
2624 // use m_editor which we had decided not to use initially
2625 editor = m_editor;
2626 if ( editor )
2627 editor->IncRef();
2628 }
2629 }
2630 }
2631
2632 // we're supposed to always find something
2633 wxASSERT_MSG(editor, wxT("Missing default cell editor"));
2634
2635 return editor;
2636 }
2637
2638 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2639 // wxGridCellAttrData
2640 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2641
2642 void wxGridCellAttrData::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row, int col)
2643 {
2644 // Note: contrary to wxGridRowOrColAttrData::SetAttr, we must not
2645 // touch attribute's reference counting explicitly, since this
2646 // is managed by class wxGridCellWithAttr
2647 int n = FindIndex(row, col);
2648 if ( n == wxNOT_FOUND )
2649 {
2650 if ( attr )
2651 {
2652 // add the attribute
2653 m_attrs.Add(new wxGridCellWithAttr(row, col, attr));
2654 }
2655 //else: nothing to do
2656 }
2657 else // we already have an attribute for this cell
2658 {
2659 if ( attr )
2660 {
2661 // change the attribute
2662 m_attrs[(size_t)n].ChangeAttr(attr);
2663 }
2664 else
2665 {
2666 // remove this attribute
2667 m_attrs.RemoveAt((size_t)n);
2668 }
2669 }
2670 }
2671
2672 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridCellAttrData::GetAttr(int row, int col) const
2673 {
2674 wxGridCellAttr *attr = (wxGridCellAttr *)NULL;
2675
2676 int n = FindIndex(row, col);
2677 if ( n != wxNOT_FOUND )
2678 {
2679 attr = m_attrs[(size_t)n].attr;
2680 attr->IncRef();
2681 }
2682
2683 return attr;
2684 }
2685
2686 void wxGridCellAttrData::UpdateAttrRows( size_t pos, int numRows )
2687 {
2688 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
2689 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
2690 {
2691 wxGridCellCoords& coords = m_attrs[n].coords;
2692 wxCoord row = coords.GetRow();
2693 if ((size_t)row >= pos)
2694 {
2695 if (numRows > 0)
2696 {
2697 // If rows inserted, include row counter where necessary
2698 coords.SetRow(row + numRows);
2699 }
2700 else if (numRows < 0)
2701 {
2702 // If rows deleted ...
2703 if ((size_t)row >= pos - numRows)
2704 {
2705 // ...either decrement row counter (if row still exists)...
2706 coords.SetRow(row + numRows);
2707 }
2708 else
2709 {
2710 // ...or remove the attribute
2711 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
2712 n--;
2713 count--;
2714 }
2715 }
2716 }
2717 }
2718 }
2719
2720 void wxGridCellAttrData::UpdateAttrCols( size_t pos, int numCols )
2721 {
2722 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
2723 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
2724 {
2725 wxGridCellCoords& coords = m_attrs[n].coords;
2726 wxCoord col = coords.GetCol();
2727 if ( (size_t)col >= pos )
2728 {
2729 if ( numCols > 0 )
2730 {
2731 // If rows inserted, include row counter where necessary
2732 coords.SetCol(col + numCols);
2733 }
2734 else if (numCols < 0)
2735 {
2736 // If rows deleted ...
2737 if ((size_t)col >= pos - numCols)
2738 {
2739 // ...either decrement row counter (if row still exists)...
2740 coords.SetCol(col + numCols);
2741 }
2742 else
2743 {
2744 // ...or remove the attribute
2745 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
2746 n--;
2747 count--;
2748 }
2749 }
2750 }
2751 }
2752 }
2753
2754 int wxGridCellAttrData::FindIndex(int row, int col) const
2755 {
2756 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
2757 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
2758 {
2759 const wxGridCellCoords& coords = m_attrs[n].coords;
2760 if ( (coords.GetRow() == row) && (coords.GetCol() == col) )
2761 {
2762 return n;
2763 }
2764 }
2765
2766 return wxNOT_FOUND;
2767 }
2768
2769 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2770 // wxGridRowOrColAttrData
2771 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2772
2773 wxGridRowOrColAttrData::~wxGridRowOrColAttrData()
2774 {
2775 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
2776 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
2777 {
2778 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
2779 }
2780 }
2781
2782 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridRowOrColAttrData::GetAttr(int rowOrCol) const
2783 {
2784 wxGridCellAttr *attr = (wxGridCellAttr *)NULL;
2785
2786 int n = m_rowsOrCols.Index(rowOrCol);
2787 if ( n != wxNOT_FOUND )
2788 {
2789 attr = m_attrs[(size_t)n];
2790 attr->IncRef();
2791 }
2792
2793 return attr;
2794 }
2795
2796 void wxGridRowOrColAttrData::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int rowOrCol)
2797 {
2798 int i = m_rowsOrCols.Index(rowOrCol);
2799 if ( i == wxNOT_FOUND )
2800 {
2801 if ( attr )
2802 {
2803 // add the attribute - no need to do anything to reference count
2804 // since we take ownership of the attribute.
2805 m_rowsOrCols.Add(rowOrCol);
2806 m_attrs.Add(attr);
2807 }
2808 // nothing to remove
2809 }
2810 else
2811 {
2812 size_t n = (size_t)i;
2813 if ( m_attrs[n] == attr )
2814 // nothing to do
2815 return;
2816 if ( attr )
2817 {
2818 // change the attribute, handling reference count manually,
2819 // taking ownership of the new attribute.
2820 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
2821 m_attrs[n] = attr;
2822 }
2823 else
2824 {
2825 // remove this attribute, handling reference count manually
2826 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
2827 m_rowsOrCols.RemoveAt(n);
2828 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
2829 }
2830 }
2831 }
2832
2833 void wxGridRowOrColAttrData::UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( size_t pos, int numRowsOrCols )
2834 {
2835 size_t count = m_attrs.GetCount();
2836 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
2837 {
2838 int & rowOrCol = m_rowsOrCols[n];
2839 if ( (size_t)rowOrCol >= pos )
2840 {
2841 if ( numRowsOrCols > 0 )
2842 {
2843 // If rows inserted, include row counter where necessary
2844 rowOrCol += numRowsOrCols;
2845 }
2846 else if ( numRowsOrCols < 0)
2847 {
2848 // If rows deleted, either decrement row counter (if row still exists)
2849 if ((size_t)rowOrCol >= pos - numRowsOrCols)
2850 rowOrCol += numRowsOrCols;
2851 else
2852 {
2853 m_rowsOrCols.RemoveAt(n);
2854 m_attrs[n]->DecRef();
2855 m_attrs.RemoveAt(n);
2856 n--;
2857 count--;
2858 }
2859 }
2860 }
2861 }
2862 }
2863
2864 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2865 // wxGridCellAttrProvider
2866 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
2867
2868 wxGridCellAttrProvider::wxGridCellAttrProvider()
2869 {
2870 m_data = (wxGridCellAttrProviderData *)NULL;
2871 }
2872
2873 wxGridCellAttrProvider::~wxGridCellAttrProvider()
2874 {
2875 delete m_data;
2876 }
2877
2878 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::InitData()
2879 {
2880 m_data = new wxGridCellAttrProviderData;
2881 }
2882
2883 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridCellAttrProvider::GetAttr(int row, int col,
2884 wxGridCellAttr::wxAttrKind kind ) const
2885 {
2886 wxGridCellAttr *attr = (wxGridCellAttr *)NULL;
2887 if ( m_data )
2888 {
2889 switch (kind)
2890 {
2891 case (wxGridCellAttr::Any):
2892 // Get cached merge attributes.
2893 // Currently not used as no cache implemented as not mutable
2894 // attr = m_data->m_mergeAttr.GetAttr(row, col);
2895 if (!attr)
2896 {
2897 // Basically implement old version.
2898 // Also check merge cache, so we don't have to re-merge every time..
2899 wxGridCellAttr *attrcell = m_data->m_cellAttrs.GetAttr(row, col);
2900 wxGridCellAttr *attrrow = m_data->m_rowAttrs.GetAttr(row);
2901 wxGridCellAttr *attrcol = m_data->m_colAttrs.GetAttr(col);
2902
2903 if ((attrcell != attrrow) && (attrrow != attrcol) && (attrcell != attrcol))
2904 {
2905 // Two or more are non NULL
2906 attr = new wxGridCellAttr;
2907 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Merged);
2908
2909 // Order is important..
2910 if (attrcell)
2911 {
2912 attr->MergeWith(attrcell);
2913 attrcell->DecRef();
2914 }
2915 if (attrcol)
2916 {
2917 attr->MergeWith(attrcol);
2918 attrcol->DecRef();
2919 }
2920 if (attrrow)
2921 {
2922 attr->MergeWith(attrrow);
2923 attrrow->DecRef();
2924 }
2925
2926 // store merge attr if cache implemented
2927 //attr->IncRef();
2928 //m_data->m_mergeAttr.SetAttr(attr, row, col);
2929 }
2930 else
2931 {
2932 // one or none is non null return it or null.
2933 if (attrrow)
2934 attr = attrrow;
2935 if (attrcol)
2936 {
2937 if (attr)
2938 attr->DecRef();
2939 attr = attrcol;
2940 }
2941 if (attrcell)
2942 {
2943 if (attr)
2944 attr->DecRef();
2945 attr = attrcell;
2946 }
2947 }
2948 }
2949 break;
2950
2951 case (wxGridCellAttr::Cell):
2952 attr = m_data->m_cellAttrs.GetAttr(row, col);
2953 break;
2954
2955 case (wxGridCellAttr::Col):
2956 attr = m_data->m_colAttrs.GetAttr(col);
2957 break;
2958
2959 case (wxGridCellAttr::Row):
2960 attr = m_data->m_rowAttrs.GetAttr(row);
2961 break;
2962
2963 default:
2964 // unused as yet...
2965 // (wxGridCellAttr::Default):
2966 // (wxGridCellAttr::Merged):
2967 break;
2968 }
2969 }
2970
2971 return attr;
2972 }
2973
2974 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr,
2975 int row, int col)
2976 {
2977 if ( !m_data )
2978 InitData();
2979
2980 m_data->m_cellAttrs.SetAttr(attr, row, col);
2981 }
2982
2983 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::SetRowAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row)
2984 {
2985 if ( !m_data )
2986 InitData();
2987
2988 m_data->m_rowAttrs.SetAttr(attr, row);
2989 }
2990
2991 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::SetColAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int col)
2992 {
2993 if ( !m_data )
2994 InitData();
2995
2996 m_data->m_colAttrs.SetAttr(attr, col);
2997 }
2998
2999 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::UpdateAttrRows( size_t pos, int numRows )
3000 {
3001 if ( m_data )
3002 {
3003 m_data->m_cellAttrs.UpdateAttrRows( pos, numRows );
3004
3005 m_data->m_rowAttrs.UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( pos, numRows );
3006 }
3007 }
3008
3009 void wxGridCellAttrProvider::UpdateAttrCols( size_t pos, int numCols )
3010 {
3011 if ( m_data )
3012 {
3013 m_data->m_cellAttrs.UpdateAttrCols( pos, numCols );
3014
3015 m_data->m_colAttrs.UpdateAttrRowsOrCols( pos, numCols );
3016 }
3017 }
3018
3019 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3020 // wxGridTypeRegistry
3021 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3022
3023 wxGridTypeRegistry::~wxGridTypeRegistry()
3024 {
3025 size_t count = m_typeinfo.GetCount();
3026 for ( size_t i = 0; i < count; i++ )
3027 delete m_typeinfo[i];
3028 }
3029
3030 void wxGridTypeRegistry::RegisterDataType(const wxString& typeName,
3031 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
3032 wxGridCellEditor* editor)
3033 {
3034 wxGridDataTypeInfo* info = new wxGridDataTypeInfo(typeName, renderer, editor);
3035
3036 // is it already registered?
3037 int loc = FindRegisteredDataType(typeName);
3038 if ( loc != wxNOT_FOUND )
3039 {
3040 delete m_typeinfo[loc];
3041 m_typeinfo[loc] = info;
3042 }
3043 else
3044 {
3045 m_typeinfo.Add(info);
3046 }
3047 }
3048
3049 int wxGridTypeRegistry::FindRegisteredDataType(const wxString& typeName)
3050 {
3051 size_t count = m_typeinfo.GetCount();
3052 for ( size_t i = 0; i < count; i++ )
3053 {
3054 if ( typeName == m_typeinfo[i]->m_typeName )
3055 {
3056 return i;
3057 }
3058 }
3059
3060 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3061 }
3062
3063 int wxGridTypeRegistry::FindDataType(const wxString& typeName)
3064 {
3065 int index = FindRegisteredDataType(typeName);
3066 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
3067 {
3068 // check whether this is one of the standard ones, in which case
3069 // register it "on the fly"
3070 #if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3071 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_STRING )
3072 {
3073 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING,
3074 new wxGridCellStringRenderer,
3075 new wxGridCellTextEditor);
3076 }
3077 else
3078 #endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3079 #if wxUSE_CHECKBOX
3080 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL )
3081 {
3082 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL,
3083 new wxGridCellBoolRenderer,
3084 new wxGridCellBoolEditor);
3085 }
3086 else
3087 #endif // wxUSE_CHECKBOX
3088 #if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3089 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER )
3090 {
3091 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER,
3092 new wxGridCellNumberRenderer,
3093 new wxGridCellNumberEditor);
3094 }
3095 else if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT )
3096 {
3097 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT,
3098 new wxGridCellFloatRenderer,
3099 new wxGridCellFloatEditor);
3100 }
3101 else
3102 #endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
3103 #if wxUSE_COMBOBOX
3104 if ( typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_CHOICE )
3105 {
3106 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_CHOICE,
3107 new wxGridCellStringRenderer,
3108 new wxGridCellChoiceEditor);
3109 }
3110 else
3111 #endif // wxUSE_COMBOBOX
3112 {
3113 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3114 }
3115
3116 // we get here only if just added the entry for this type, so return
3117 // the last index
3118 index = m_typeinfo.GetCount() - 1;
3119 }
3120
3121 return index;
3122 }
3123
3124 int wxGridTypeRegistry::FindOrCloneDataType(const wxString& typeName)
3125 {
3126 int index = FindDataType(typeName);
3127 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
3128 {
3129 // the first part of the typename is the "real" type, anything after ':'
3130 // are the parameters for the renderer
3131 index = FindDataType(typeName.BeforeFirst(_T(':')));
3132 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
3133 {
3134 return wxNOT_FOUND;
3135 }
3136
3137 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = GetRenderer(index);
3138 wxGridCellRenderer *rendererOld = renderer;
3139 renderer = renderer->Clone();
3140 rendererOld->DecRef();
3141
3142 wxGridCellEditor *editor = GetEditor(index);
3143 wxGridCellEditor *editorOld = editor;
3144 editor = editor->Clone();
3145 editorOld->DecRef();
3146
3147 // do it even if there are no parameters to reset them to defaults
3148 wxString params = typeName.AfterFirst(_T(':'));
3149 renderer->SetParameters(params);
3150 editor->SetParameters(params);
3151
3152 // register the new typename
3153 RegisterDataType(typeName, renderer, editor);
3154
3155 // we just registered it, it's the last one
3156 index = m_typeinfo.GetCount() - 1;
3157 }
3158
3159 return index;
3160 }
3161
3162 wxGridCellRenderer* wxGridTypeRegistry::GetRenderer(int index)
3163 {
3164 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer = m_typeinfo[index]->m_renderer;
3165 if (renderer)
3166 renderer->IncRef();
3167
3168 return renderer;
3169 }
3170
3171 wxGridCellEditor* wxGridTypeRegistry::GetEditor(int index)
3172 {
3173 wxGridCellEditor* editor = m_typeinfo[index]->m_editor;
3174 if (editor)
3175 editor->IncRef();
3176
3177 return editor;
3178 }
3179
3180 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3181 // wxGridTableBase
3182 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3183
3184 IMPLEMENT_ABSTRACT_CLASS( wxGridTableBase, wxObject )
3185
3186 wxGridTableBase::wxGridTableBase()
3187 {
3188 m_view = (wxGrid *) NULL;
3189 m_attrProvider = (wxGridCellAttrProvider *) NULL;
3190 }
3191
3192 wxGridTableBase::~wxGridTableBase()
3193 {
3194 delete m_attrProvider;
3195 }
3196
3197 void wxGridTableBase::SetAttrProvider(wxGridCellAttrProvider *attrProvider)
3198 {
3199 delete m_attrProvider;
3200 m_attrProvider = attrProvider;
3201 }
3202
3203 bool wxGridTableBase::CanHaveAttributes()
3204 {
3205 if ( ! GetAttrProvider() )
3206 {
3207 // use the default attr provider by default
3208 SetAttrProvider(new wxGridCellAttrProvider);
3209 }
3210
3211 return true;
3212 }
3213
3214 wxGridCellAttr *wxGridTableBase::GetAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr::wxAttrKind kind)
3215 {
3216 if ( m_attrProvider )
3217 return m_attrProvider->GetAttr(row, col, kind);
3218 else
3219 return (wxGridCellAttr *)NULL;
3220 }
3221
3222 void wxGridTableBase::SetAttr(wxGridCellAttr* attr, int row, int col)
3223 {
3224 if ( m_attrProvider )
3225 {
3226 if ( attr )
3227 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Cell);
3228 m_attrProvider->SetAttr(attr, row, col);
3229 }
3230 else
3231 {
3232 // as we take ownership of the pointer and don't store it, we must
3233 // free it now
3234 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
3235 }
3236 }
3237
3238 void wxGridTableBase::SetRowAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int row)
3239 {
3240 if ( m_attrProvider )
3241 {
3242 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Row);
3243 m_attrProvider->SetRowAttr(attr, row);
3244 }
3245 else
3246 {
3247 // as we take ownership of the pointer and don't store it, we must
3248 // free it now
3249 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
3250 }
3251 }
3252
3253 void wxGridTableBase::SetColAttr(wxGridCellAttr *attr, int col)
3254 {
3255 if ( m_attrProvider )
3256 {
3257 attr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Col);
3258 m_attrProvider->SetColAttr(attr, col);
3259 }
3260 else
3261 {
3262 // as we take ownership of the pointer and don't store it, we must
3263 // free it now
3264 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
3265 }
3266 }
3267
3268 bool wxGridTableBase::InsertRows( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3269 size_t WXUNUSED(numRows) )
3270 {
3271 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function InsertRows\nbut your derived table class does not override this function") );
3272
3273 return false;
3274 }
3275
3276 bool wxGridTableBase::AppendRows( size_t WXUNUSED(numRows) )
3277 {
3278 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function AppendRows\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3279
3280 return false;
3281 }
3282
3283 bool wxGridTableBase::DeleteRows( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3284 size_t WXUNUSED(numRows) )
3285 {
3286 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function DeleteRows\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3287
3288 return false;
3289 }
3290
3291 bool wxGridTableBase::InsertCols( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3292 size_t WXUNUSED(numCols) )
3293 {
3294 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function InsertCols\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3295
3296 return false;
3297 }
3298
3299 bool wxGridTableBase::AppendCols( size_t WXUNUSED(numCols) )
3300 {
3301 wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("Called grid table class function AppendCols\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3302
3303 return false;
3304 }
3305
3306 bool wxGridTableBase::DeleteCols( size_t WXUNUSED(pos),
3307 size_t WXUNUSED(numCols) )
3308 {
3309 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called grid table class function DeleteCols\nbut your derived table class does not override this function"));
3310
3311 return false;
3312 }
3313
3314 wxString wxGridTableBase::GetRowLabelValue( int row )
3315 {
3316 wxString s;
3317
3318 // RD: Starting the rows at zero confuses users,
3319 // no matter how much it makes sense to us geeks.
3320 s << row + 1;
3321
3322 return s;
3323 }
3324
3325 wxString wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue( int col )
3326 {
3327 // default col labels are:
3328 // cols 0 to 25 : A-Z
3329 // cols 26 to 675 : AA-ZZ
3330 // etc.
3331
3332 wxString s;
3333 unsigned int i, n;
3334 for ( n = 1; ; n++ )
3335 {
3336 s += (wxChar) (_T('A') + (wxChar)(col % 26));
3337 col = col / 26 - 1;
3338 if ( col < 0 )
3339 break;
3340 }
3341
3342 // reverse the string...
3343 wxString s2;
3344 for ( i = 0; i < n; i++ )
3345 {
3346 s2 += s[n - i - 1];
3347 }
3348
3349 return s2;
3350 }
3351
3352 wxString wxGridTableBase::GetTypeName( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3353 {
3354 return wxGRID_VALUE_STRING;
3355 }
3356
3357 bool wxGridTableBase::CanGetValueAs( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3358 const wxString& typeName )
3359 {
3360 return typeName == wxGRID_VALUE_STRING;
3361 }
3362
3363 bool wxGridTableBase::CanSetValueAs( int row, int col, const wxString& typeName )
3364 {
3365 return CanGetValueAs(row, col, typeName);
3366 }
3367
3368 long wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsLong( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3369 {
3370 return 0;
3371 }
3372
3373 double wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsDouble( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3374 {
3375 return 0.0;
3376 }
3377
3378 bool wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsBool( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col) )
3379 {
3380 return false;
3381 }
3382
3383 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsLong( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3384 long WXUNUSED(value) )
3385 {
3386 }
3387
3388 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsDouble( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3389 double WXUNUSED(value) )
3390 {
3391 }
3392
3393 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsBool( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3394 bool WXUNUSED(value) )
3395 {
3396 }
3397
3398 void* wxGridTableBase::GetValueAsCustom( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3399 const wxString& WXUNUSED(typeName) )
3400 {
3401 return NULL;
3402 }
3403
3404 void wxGridTableBase::SetValueAsCustom( int WXUNUSED(row), int WXUNUSED(col),
3405 const wxString& WXUNUSED(typeName),
3406 void* WXUNUSED(value) )
3407 {
3408 }
3409
3410 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3411 //
3412 // Message class for the grid table to send requests and notifications
3413 // to the grid view
3414 //
3415
3416 wxGridTableMessage::wxGridTableMessage()
3417 {
3418 m_table = (wxGridTableBase *) NULL;
3419 m_id = -1;
3420 m_comInt1 = -1;
3421 m_comInt2 = -1;
3422 }
3423
3424 wxGridTableMessage::wxGridTableMessage( wxGridTableBase *table, int id,
3425 int commandInt1, int commandInt2 )
3426 {
3427 m_table = table;
3428 m_id = id;
3429 m_comInt1 = commandInt1;
3430 m_comInt2 = commandInt2;
3431 }
3432
3433 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3434 //
3435 // A basic grid table for string data. An object of this class will
3436 // created by wxGrid if you don't specify an alternative table class.
3437 //
3438
3439 WX_DEFINE_OBJARRAY(wxGridStringArray)
3440
3441 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridStringTable, wxGridTableBase )
3442
3443 wxGridStringTable::wxGridStringTable()
3444 : wxGridTableBase()
3445 {
3446 }
3447
3448 wxGridStringTable::wxGridStringTable( int numRows, int numCols )
3449 : wxGridTableBase()
3450 {
3451 m_data.Alloc( numRows );
3452
3453 wxArrayString sa;
3454 sa.Alloc( numCols );
3455 sa.Add( wxEmptyString, numCols );
3456
3457 m_data.Add( sa, numRows );
3458 }
3459
3460 wxGridStringTable::~wxGridStringTable()
3461 {
3462 }
3463
3464 int wxGridStringTable::GetNumberRows()
3465 {
3466 return m_data.GetCount();
3467 }
3468
3469 int wxGridStringTable::GetNumberCols()
3470 {
3471 if ( m_data.GetCount() > 0 )
3472 return m_data[0].GetCount();
3473 else
3474 return 0;
3475 }
3476
3477 wxString wxGridStringTable::GetValue( int row, int col )
3478 {
3479 wxCHECK_MSG( (row < GetNumberRows()) && (col < GetNumberCols()),
3480 wxEmptyString,
3481 _T("invalid row or column index in wxGridStringTable") );
3482
3483 return m_data[row][col];
3484 }
3485
3486 void wxGridStringTable::SetValue( int row, int col, const wxString& value )
3487 {
3488 wxCHECK_RET( (row < GetNumberRows()) && (col < GetNumberCols()),
3489 _T("invalid row or column index in wxGridStringTable") );
3490
3491 m_data[row][col] = value;
3492 }
3493
3494 bool wxGridStringTable::IsEmptyCell( int row, int col )
3495 {
3496 wxCHECK_MSG( (row < GetNumberRows()) && (col < GetNumberCols()),
3497 true,
3498 _T("invalid row or column index in wxGridStringTable") );
3499
3500 return (m_data[row][col] == wxEmptyString);
3501 }
3502
3503 void wxGridStringTable::Clear()
3504 {
3505 int row, col;
3506 int numRows, numCols;
3507
3508 numRows = m_data.GetCount();
3509 if ( numRows > 0 )
3510 {
3511 numCols = m_data[0].GetCount();
3512
3513 for ( row = 0; row < numRows; row++ )
3514 {
3515 for ( col = 0; col < numCols; col++ )
3516 {
3517 m_data[row][col] = wxEmptyString;
3518 }
3519 }
3520 }
3521 }
3522
3523 bool wxGridStringTable::InsertRows( size_t pos, size_t numRows )
3524 {
3525 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3526 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0 ? m_data[0].GetCount() :
3527 ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3528
3529 if ( pos >= curNumRows )
3530 {
3531 return AppendRows( numRows );
3532 }
3533
3534 wxArrayString sa;
3535 sa.Alloc( curNumCols );
3536 sa.Add( wxEmptyString, curNumCols );
3537 m_data.Insert( sa, pos, numRows );
3538
3539 if ( GetView() )
3540 {
3541 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3542 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_INSERTED,
3543 pos,
3544 numRows );
3545
3546 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3547 }
3548
3549 return true;
3550 }
3551
3552 bool wxGridStringTable::AppendRows( size_t numRows )
3553 {
3554 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3555 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0
3556 ? m_data[0].GetCount()
3557 : ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3558
3559 wxArrayString sa;
3560 if ( curNumCols > 0 )
3561 {
3562 sa.Alloc( curNumCols );
3563 sa.Add( wxEmptyString, curNumCols );
3564 }
3565
3566 m_data.Add( sa, numRows );
3567
3568 if ( GetView() )
3569 {
3570 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3571 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_APPENDED,
3572 numRows );
3573
3574 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3575 }
3576
3577 return true;
3578 }
3579
3580 bool wxGridStringTable::DeleteRows( size_t pos, size_t numRows )
3581 {
3582 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3583
3584 if ( pos >= curNumRows )
3585 {
3586 wxFAIL_MSG( wxString::Format
3587 (
3588 wxT("Called wxGridStringTable::DeleteRows(pos=%lu, N=%lu)\nPos value is invalid for present table with %lu rows"),
3589 (unsigned long)pos,
3590 (unsigned long)numRows,
3591 (unsigned long)curNumRows
3592 ) );
3593
3594 return false;
3595 }
3596
3597 if ( numRows > curNumRows - pos )
3598 {
3599 numRows = curNumRows - pos;
3600 }
3601
3602 if ( numRows >= curNumRows )
3603 {
3604 m_data.Clear();
3605 }
3606 else
3607 {
3608 m_data.RemoveAt( pos, numRows );
3609 }
3610
3611 if ( GetView() )
3612 {
3613 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3614 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_DELETED,
3615 pos,
3616 numRows );
3617
3618 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3619 }
3620
3621 return true;
3622 }
3623
3624 bool wxGridStringTable::InsertCols( size_t pos, size_t numCols )
3625 {
3626 size_t row, col;
3627
3628 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3629 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0
3630 ? m_data[0].GetCount()
3631 : ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3632
3633 if ( pos >= curNumCols )
3634 {
3635 return AppendCols( numCols );
3636 }
3637
3638 if ( !m_colLabels.IsEmpty() )
3639 {
3640 m_colLabels.Insert( wxEmptyString, pos, numCols );
3641
3642 size_t i;
3643 for ( i = pos; i < pos + numCols; i++ )
3644 m_colLabels[i] = wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue( i );
3645 }
3646
3647 for ( row = 0; row < curNumRows; row++ )
3648 {
3649 for ( col = pos; col < pos + numCols; col++ )
3650 {
3651 m_data[row].Insert( wxEmptyString, col );
3652 }
3653 }
3654
3655 if ( GetView() )
3656 {
3657 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3658 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_INSERTED,
3659 pos,
3660 numCols );
3661
3662 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3663 }
3664
3665 return true;
3666 }
3667
3668 bool wxGridStringTable::AppendCols( size_t numCols )
3669 {
3670 size_t row;
3671
3672 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3673
3674 #if 0
3675 if ( !curNumRows )
3676 {
3677 // TODO: something better than this ?
3678 //
3679 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Unable to append cols to a grid table with no rows.\nCall AppendRows() first") );
3680 return false;
3681 }
3682 #endif
3683
3684 for ( row = 0; row < curNumRows; row++ )
3685 {
3686 m_data[row].Add( wxEmptyString, numCols );
3687 }
3688
3689 if ( GetView() )
3690 {
3691 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3692 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_APPENDED,
3693 numCols );
3694
3695 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3696 }
3697
3698 return true;
3699 }
3700
3701 bool wxGridStringTable::DeleteCols( size_t pos, size_t numCols )
3702 {
3703 size_t row;
3704
3705 size_t curNumRows = m_data.GetCount();
3706 size_t curNumCols = ( curNumRows > 0 ? m_data[0].GetCount() :
3707 ( GetView() ? GetView()->GetNumberCols() : 0 ) );
3708
3709 if ( pos >= curNumCols )
3710 {
3711 wxFAIL_MSG( wxString::Format
3712 (
3713 wxT("Called wxGridStringTable::DeleteCols(pos=%lu, N=%lu)\nPos value is invalid for present table with %lu cols"),
3714 (unsigned long)pos,
3715 (unsigned long)numCols,
3716 (unsigned long)curNumCols
3717 ) );
3718 return false;
3719 }
3720
3721 int colID;
3722 if ( GetView() )
3723 colID = GetView()->GetColAt( pos );
3724 else
3725 colID = pos;
3726
3727 if ( numCols > curNumCols - colID )
3728 {
3729 numCols = curNumCols - colID;
3730 }
3731
3732 if ( !m_colLabels.IsEmpty() )
3733 {
3734 // m_colLabels stores just as many elements as it needs, e.g. if only
3735 // the label of the first column had been set it would have only one
3736 // element and not numCols, so account for it
3737 int nToRm = m_colLabels.size() - colID;
3738 if ( nToRm > 0 )
3739 m_colLabels.RemoveAt( colID, nToRm );
3740 }
3741
3742 for ( row = 0; row < curNumRows; row++ )
3743 {
3744 if ( numCols >= curNumCols )
3745 {
3746 m_data[row].Clear();
3747 }
3748 else
3749 {
3750 m_data[row].RemoveAt( colID, numCols );
3751 }
3752 }
3753
3754 if ( GetView() )
3755 {
3756 wxGridTableMessage msg( this,
3757 wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_DELETED,
3758 pos,
3759 numCols );
3760
3761 GetView()->ProcessTableMessage( msg );
3762 }
3763
3764 return true;
3765 }
3766
3767 wxString wxGridStringTable::GetRowLabelValue( int row )
3768 {
3769 if ( row > (int)(m_rowLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
3770 {
3771 // using default label
3772 //
3773 return wxGridTableBase::GetRowLabelValue( row );
3774 }
3775 else
3776 {
3777 return m_rowLabels[row];
3778 }
3779 }
3780
3781 wxString wxGridStringTable::GetColLabelValue( int col )
3782 {
3783 if ( col > (int)(m_colLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
3784 {
3785 // using default label
3786 //
3787 return wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue( col );
3788 }
3789 else
3790 {
3791 return m_colLabels[col];
3792 }
3793 }
3794
3795 void wxGridStringTable::SetRowLabelValue( int row, const wxString& value )
3796 {
3797 if ( row > (int)(m_rowLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
3798 {
3799 int n = m_rowLabels.GetCount();
3800 int i;
3801
3802 for ( i = n; i <= row; i++ )
3803 {
3804 m_rowLabels.Add( wxGridTableBase::GetRowLabelValue(i) );
3805 }
3806 }
3807
3808 m_rowLabels[row] = value;
3809 }
3810
3811 void wxGridStringTable::SetColLabelValue( int col, const wxString& value )
3812 {
3813 if ( col > (int)(m_colLabels.GetCount()) - 1 )
3814 {
3815 int n = m_colLabels.GetCount();
3816 int i;
3817
3818 for ( i = n; i <= col; i++ )
3819 {
3820 m_colLabels.Add( wxGridTableBase::GetColLabelValue(i) );
3821 }
3822 }
3823
3824 m_colLabels[col] = value;
3825 }
3826
3827
3828 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3829 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3830
3831 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE(wxGridSubwindow, wxWindow)
3832 EVT_MOUSE_CAPTURE_LOST(wxGridSubwindow::OnMouseCaptureLost)
3833 END_EVENT_TABLE()
3834
3835 void wxGridSubwindow::OnMouseCaptureLost(wxMouseCaptureLostEvent& WXUNUSED(event))
3836 {
3837 m_owner->CancelMouseCapture();
3838 }
3839
3840 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridRowLabelWindow, wxWindow )
3841
3842 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridRowLabelWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
3843 EVT_PAINT( wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnPaint )
3844 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel )
3845 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent )
3846 END_EVENT_TABLE()
3847
3848 wxGridRowLabelWindow::wxGridRowLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent,
3849 wxWindowID id,
3850 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size )
3851 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size)
3852 {
3853 m_owner = parent;
3854 }
3855
3856 void wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
3857 {
3858 wxPaintDC dc(this);
3859
3860 // NO - don't do this because it will set both the x and y origin
3861 // coords to match the parent scrolled window and we just want to
3862 // set the y coord - MB
3863 //
3864 // m_owner->PrepareDC( dc );
3865
3866 int x, y;
3867 m_owner->CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &x, &y );
3868 wxPoint pt = dc.GetDeviceOrigin();
3869 dc.SetDeviceOrigin( pt.x, pt.y-y );
3870
3871 wxArrayInt rows = m_owner->CalcRowLabelsExposed( GetUpdateRegion() );
3872 m_owner->DrawRowLabels( dc, rows );
3873 }
3874
3875 void wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
3876 {
3877 m_owner->ProcessRowLabelMouseEvent( event );
3878 }
3879
3880 void wxGridRowLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
3881 {
3882 m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event );
3883 }
3884
3885 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3886
3887 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridColLabelWindow, wxWindow )
3888
3889 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridColLabelWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
3890 EVT_PAINT( wxGridColLabelWindow::OnPaint )
3891 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel )
3892 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent )
3893 END_EVENT_TABLE()
3894
3895 wxGridColLabelWindow::wxGridColLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent,
3896 wxWindowID id,
3897 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size )
3898 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size)
3899 {
3900 m_owner = parent;
3901 }
3902
3903 void wxGridColLabelWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
3904 {
3905 wxPaintDC dc(this);
3906
3907 // NO - don't do this because it will set both the x and y origin
3908 // coords to match the parent scrolled window and we just want to
3909 // set the x coord - MB
3910 //
3911 // m_owner->PrepareDC( dc );
3912
3913 int x, y;
3914 m_owner->CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &x, &y );
3915 wxPoint pt = dc.GetDeviceOrigin();
3916 if (GetLayoutDirection() == wxLayout_RightToLeft)
3917 dc.SetDeviceOrigin( pt.x+x, pt.y );
3918 else
3919 dc.SetDeviceOrigin( pt.x-x, pt.y );
3920
3921 wxArrayInt cols = m_owner->CalcColLabelsExposed( GetUpdateRegion() );
3922 m_owner->DrawColLabels( dc, cols );
3923 }
3924
3925 void wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
3926 {
3927 m_owner->ProcessColLabelMouseEvent( event );
3928 }
3929
3930 void wxGridColLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
3931 {
3932 m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event );
3933 }
3934
3935 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3936
3937 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridCornerLabelWindow, wxWindow )
3938
3939 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridCornerLabelWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
3940 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel )
3941 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent )
3942 EVT_PAINT( wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnPaint )
3943 END_EVENT_TABLE()
3944
3945 wxGridCornerLabelWindow::wxGridCornerLabelWindow( wxGrid *parent,
3946 wxWindowID id,
3947 const wxPoint &pos, const wxSize &size )
3948 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size)
3949 {
3950 m_owner = parent;
3951 }
3952
3953 void wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
3954 {
3955 wxPaintDC dc(this);
3956
3957 int client_height = 0;
3958 int client_width = 0;
3959 GetClientSize( &client_width, &client_height );
3960
3961 // VZ: any reason for this ifdef? (FIXME)
3962 #if 0
3963 def __WXGTK__
3964 wxRect rect;
3965 rect.SetX( 1 );
3966 rect.SetY( 1 );
3967 rect.SetWidth( client_width - 2 );
3968 rect.SetHeight( client_height - 2 );
3969
3970 wxRendererNative::Get().DrawHeaderButton( this, dc, rect, 0 );
3971 #else // !__WXGTK__
3972 dc.SetPen( wxPen(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_3DSHADOW), 1, wxPENSTYLE_SOLID) );
3973 dc.DrawLine( client_width - 1, client_height - 1, client_width - 1, 0 );
3974 dc.DrawLine( client_width - 1, client_height - 1, 0, client_height - 1 );
3975 dc.DrawLine( 0, 0, client_width, 0 );
3976 dc.DrawLine( 0, 0, 0, client_height );
3977
3978 dc.SetPen( *wxWHITE_PEN );
3979 dc.DrawLine( 1, 1, client_width - 1, 1 );
3980 dc.DrawLine( 1, 1, 1, client_height - 1 );
3981 #endif
3982 }
3983
3984 void wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
3985 {
3986 m_owner->ProcessCornerLabelMouseEvent( event );
3987 }
3988
3989 void wxGridCornerLabelWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
3990 {
3991 m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
3992 }
3993
3994 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3995
3996 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridWindow, wxWindow )
3997
3998 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGridWindow, wxGridSubwindow )
3999 EVT_PAINT( wxGridWindow::OnPaint )
4000 EVT_MOUSEWHEEL( wxGridWindow::OnMouseWheel )
4001 EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS( wxGridWindow::OnMouseEvent )
4002 EVT_KEY_DOWN( wxGridWindow::OnKeyDown )
4003 EVT_KEY_UP( wxGridWindow::OnKeyUp )
4004 EVT_CHAR( wxGridWindow::OnChar )
4005 EVT_SET_FOCUS( wxGridWindow::OnFocus )
4006 EVT_KILL_FOCUS( wxGridWindow::OnFocus )
4007 EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND( wxGridWindow::OnEraseBackground )
4008 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4009
4010 wxGridWindow::wxGridWindow( wxGrid *parent,
4011 wxGridRowLabelWindow *rowLblWin,
4012 wxGridColLabelWindow *colLblWin,
4013 wxWindowID id,
4014 const wxPoint &pos,
4015 const wxSize &size )
4016 : wxGridSubwindow(parent, id, pos, size,
4017 wxWANTS_CHARS | wxCLIP_CHILDREN,
4018 wxT("grid window") )
4019 {
4020 m_owner = parent;
4021 m_rowLabelWin = rowLblWin;
4022 m_colLabelWin = colLblWin;
4023 }
4024
4025 void wxGridWindow::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent &WXUNUSED(event) )
4026 {
4027 wxPaintDC dc( this );
4028 m_owner->PrepareDC( dc );
4029 wxRegion reg = GetUpdateRegion();
4030 wxGridCellCoordsArray dirtyCells = m_owner->CalcCellsExposed( reg );
4031 m_owner->DrawGridCellArea( dc, dirtyCells );
4032
4033 #if WXGRID_DRAW_LINES
4034 m_owner->DrawAllGridLines( dc, reg );
4035 #endif
4036
4037 m_owner->DrawGridSpace( dc );
4038 m_owner->DrawHighlight( dc, dirtyCells );
4039 }
4040
4041 void wxGridWindow::ScrollWindow( int dx, int dy, const wxRect *rect )
4042 {
4043 wxWindow::ScrollWindow( dx, dy, rect );
4044 m_rowLabelWin->ScrollWindow( 0, dy, rect );
4045 m_colLabelWin->ScrollWindow( dx, 0, rect );
4046 }
4047
4048 void wxGridWindow::OnMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
4049 {
4050 if (event.ButtonDown(wxMOUSE_BTN_LEFT) && FindFocus() != this)
4051 SetFocus();
4052
4053 m_owner->ProcessGridCellMouseEvent( event );
4054 }
4055
4056 void wxGridWindow::OnMouseWheel( wxMouseEvent& event )
4057 {
4058 m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event );
4059 }
4060
4061 // This seems to be required for wxMotif/wxGTK otherwise the mouse
4062 // cursor must be in the cell edit control to get key events
4063 //
4064 void wxGridWindow::OnKeyDown( wxKeyEvent& event )
4065 {
4066 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4067 event.Skip();
4068 }
4069
4070 void wxGridWindow::OnKeyUp( wxKeyEvent& event )
4071 {
4072 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4073 event.Skip();
4074 }
4075
4076 void wxGridWindow::OnChar( wxKeyEvent& event )
4077 {
4078 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4079 event.Skip();
4080 }
4081
4082 void wxGridWindow::OnEraseBackground( wxEraseEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
4083 {
4084 }
4085
4086 void wxGridWindow::OnFocus(wxFocusEvent& event)
4087 {
4088 // and if we have any selection, it has to be repainted, because it
4089 // uses different colour when the grid is not focused:
4090 if ( m_owner->IsSelection() )
4091 {
4092 Refresh();
4093 }
4094 else
4095 {
4096 // NB: Note that this code is in "else" branch only because the other
4097 // branch refreshes everything and so there's no point in calling
4098 // Refresh() again, *not* because it should only be done if
4099 // !IsSelection(). If the above code is ever optimized to refresh
4100 // only selected area, this needs to be moved out of the "else"
4101 // branch so that it's always executed.
4102
4103 // current cell cursor {dis,re}appears on focus change:
4104 const wxGridCellCoords cursorCoords(m_owner->GetGridCursorRow(),
4105 m_owner->GetGridCursorCol());
4106 const wxRect cursor =
4107 m_owner->BlockToDeviceRect(cursorCoords, cursorCoords);
4108 Refresh(true, &cursor);
4109 }
4110
4111 if ( !m_owner->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( event ) )
4112 event.Skip();
4113 }
4114
4115 //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4116
4117 // Internal Helper function for computing row or column from some
4118 // (unscrolled) coordinate value, using either
4119 // m_defaultRowHeight/m_defaultColWidth or binary search on array
4120 // of m_rowBottoms/m_ColRights to speed up the search!
4121
4122 // Internal helper macros for simpler use of that function
4123
4124 static int CoordToRowOrCol(int coord, int defaultDist, int minDist,
4125 const wxArrayInt& BorderArray, int nMax,
4126 bool clipToMinMax);
4127
4128 #define internalXToCol(x) XToCol(x, true)
4129 #define internalYToRow(y) CoordToRowOrCol(y, m_defaultRowHeight, \
4130 m_minAcceptableRowHeight, \
4131 m_rowBottoms, m_numRows, true)
4132
4133 /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4134
4135 #if wxUSE_EXTENDED_RTTI
4136 WX_DEFINE_FLAGS( wxGridStyle )
4137
4138 wxBEGIN_FLAGS( wxGridStyle )
4139 // new style border flags, we put them first to
4140 // use them for streaming out
4141 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_SIMPLE)
4142 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_SUNKEN)
4143 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_DOUBLE)
4144 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_RAISED)
4145 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_STATIC)
4146 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_NONE)
4147
4148 // old style border flags
4149 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSIMPLE_BORDER)
4150 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSUNKEN_BORDER)
4151 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxDOUBLE_BORDER)
4152 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxRAISED_BORDER)
4153 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSTATIC_BORDER)
4154 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER)
4155
4156 // standard window styles
4157 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxTAB_TRAVERSAL)
4158 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxCLIP_CHILDREN)
4159 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxTRANSPARENT_WINDOW)
4160 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxWANTS_CHARS)
4161 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxFULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE)
4162 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxALWAYS_SHOW_SB)
4163 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxVSCROLL)
4164 wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxHSCROLL)
4165
4166 wxEND_FLAGS( wxGridStyle )
4167
4168 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS_XTI(wxGrid, wxScrolledWindow,"wx/grid.h")
4169
4170 wxBEGIN_PROPERTIES_TABLE(wxGrid)
4171 wxHIDE_PROPERTY( Children )
4172 wxPROPERTY_FLAGS( WindowStyle , wxGridStyle , long , SetWindowStyleFlag , GetWindowStyleFlag , EMPTY_MACROVALUE, 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // style
4173 wxEND_PROPERTIES_TABLE()
4174
4175 wxBEGIN_HANDLERS_TABLE(wxGrid)
4176 wxEND_HANDLERS_TABLE()
4177
4178 wxCONSTRUCTOR_5( wxGrid , wxWindow* , Parent , wxWindowID , Id , wxPoint , Position , wxSize , Size , long , WindowStyle )
4179
4180 /*
4181 TODO : Expose more information of a list's layout, etc. via appropriate objects (e.g., NotebookPageInfo)
4182 */
4183 #else
4184 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGrid, wxScrolledWindow )
4185 #endif
4186
4187 BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE( wxGrid, wxScrolledWindow )
4188 EVT_PAINT( wxGrid::OnPaint )
4189 EVT_SIZE( wxGrid::OnSize )
4190 EVT_KEY_DOWN( wxGrid::OnKeyDown )
4191 EVT_KEY_UP( wxGrid::OnKeyUp )
4192 EVT_CHAR ( wxGrid::OnChar )
4193 EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND( wxGrid::OnEraseBackground )
4194 END_EVENT_TABLE()
4195
4196 wxGrid::wxGrid()
4197 {
4198 InitVars();
4199 }
4200
4201 wxGrid::wxGrid( wxWindow *parent,
4202 wxWindowID id,
4203 const wxPoint& pos,
4204 const wxSize& size,
4205 long style,
4206 const wxString& name )
4207 {
4208 InitVars();
4209 Create(parent, id, pos, size, style, name);
4210 }
4211
4212 bool wxGrid::Create(wxWindow *parent, wxWindowID id,
4213 const wxPoint& pos, const wxSize& size,
4214 long style, const wxString& name)
4215 {
4216 if (!wxScrolledWindow::Create(parent, id, pos, size,
4217 style | wxWANTS_CHARS, name))
4218 return false;
4219
4220 m_colMinWidths = wxLongToLongHashMap(GRID_HASH_SIZE);
4221 m_rowMinHeights = wxLongToLongHashMap(GRID_HASH_SIZE);
4222
4223 Create();
4224 SetInitialSize(size);
4225 CalcDimensions();
4226
4227 return true;
4228 }
4229
4230 wxGrid::~wxGrid()
4231 {
4232 // Must do this or ~wxScrollHelper will pop the wrong event handler
4233 SetTargetWindow(this);
4234 ClearAttrCache();
4235 wxSafeDecRef(m_defaultCellAttr);
4236
4237 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
4238 size_t total = gs_nAttrCacheHits + gs_nAttrCacheMisses;
4239 wxPrintf(_T("wxGrid attribute cache statistics: "
4240 "total: %u, hits: %u (%u%%)\n"),
4241 total, gs_nAttrCacheHits,
4242 total ? (gs_nAttrCacheHits*100) / total : 0);
4243 #endif
4244
4245 // if we own the table, just delete it, otherwise at least don't leave it
4246 // with dangling view pointer
4247 if ( m_ownTable )
4248 delete m_table;
4249 else if ( m_table && m_table->GetView() == this )
4250 m_table->SetView(NULL);
4251
4252 delete m_typeRegistry;
4253 delete m_selection;
4254 }
4255
4256 //
4257 // ----- internal init and update functions
4258 //
4259
4260 // NOTE: If using the default visual attributes works everywhere then this can
4261 // be removed as well as the #else cases below.
4262 #define _USE_VISATTR 0
4263
4264 void wxGrid::Create()
4265 {
4266 // create the type registry
4267 m_typeRegistry = new wxGridTypeRegistry;
4268
4269 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = false;
4270
4271 m_defaultCellAttr = new wxGridCellAttr();
4272
4273 // Set default cell attributes
4274 m_defaultCellAttr->SetDefAttr(m_defaultCellAttr);
4275 m_defaultCellAttr->SetKind(wxGridCellAttr::Default);
4276 m_defaultCellAttr->SetFont(GetFont());
4277 m_defaultCellAttr->SetAlignment(wxALIGN_LEFT, wxALIGN_TOP);
4278 m_defaultCellAttr->SetRenderer(new wxGridCellStringRenderer);
4279 m_defaultCellAttr->SetEditor(new wxGridCellTextEditor);
4280
4281 #if _USE_VISATTR
4282 wxVisualAttributes gva = wxListBox::GetClassDefaultAttributes();
4283 wxVisualAttributes lva = wxPanel::GetClassDefaultAttributes();
4284
4285 m_defaultCellAttr->SetTextColour(gva.colFg);
4286 m_defaultCellAttr->SetBackgroundColour(gva.colBg);
4287
4288 #else
4289 m_defaultCellAttr->SetTextColour(
4290 wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT));
4291 m_defaultCellAttr->SetBackgroundColour(
4292 wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOW));
4293 #endif
4294
4295 m_numRows = 0;
4296 m_numCols = 0;
4297 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4298
4299 m_rowLabelWidth = WXGRID_DEFAULT_ROW_LABEL_WIDTH;
4300 m_colLabelHeight = WXGRID_DEFAULT_COL_LABEL_HEIGHT;
4301
4302 // subwindow components that make up the wxGrid
4303 m_rowLabelWin = new wxGridRowLabelWindow( this,
4304 wxID_ANY,
4305 wxDefaultPosition,
4306 wxDefaultSize );
4307
4308 m_colLabelWin = new wxGridColLabelWindow( this,
4309 wxID_ANY,
4310 wxDefaultPosition,
4311 wxDefaultSize );
4312
4313 m_cornerLabelWin = new wxGridCornerLabelWindow( this,
4314 wxID_ANY,
4315 wxDefaultPosition,
4316 wxDefaultSize );
4317
4318 m_gridWin = new wxGridWindow( this,
4319 m_rowLabelWin,
4320 m_colLabelWin,
4321 wxID_ANY,
4322 wxDefaultPosition,
4323 wxDefaultSize );
4324
4325 SetTargetWindow( m_gridWin );
4326
4327 #if _USE_VISATTR
4328 wxColour gfg = gva.colFg;
4329 wxColour gbg = gva.colBg;
4330 wxColour lfg = lva.colFg;
4331 wxColour lbg = lva.colBg;
4332 #else
4333 wxColour gfg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT );
4334 wxColour gbg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOW );
4335 wxColour lfg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT );
4336 wxColour lbg = wxSystemSettings::GetColour( wxSYS_COLOUR_BTNFACE );
4337 #endif
4338
4339 m_cornerLabelWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(lfg);
4340 m_cornerLabelWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(lbg);
4341 m_rowLabelWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(lfg);
4342 m_rowLabelWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(lbg);
4343 m_colLabelWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(lfg);
4344 m_colLabelWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(lbg);
4345
4346 m_gridWin->SetOwnForegroundColour(gfg);
4347 m_gridWin->SetOwnBackgroundColour(gbg);
4348
4349 Init();
4350 }
4351
4352 bool wxGrid::CreateGrid( int numRows, int numCols,
4353 wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes selmode )
4354 {
4355 wxCHECK_MSG( !m_created,
4356 false,
4357 wxT("wxGrid::CreateGrid or wxGrid::SetTable called more than once") );
4358
4359 m_numRows = numRows;
4360 m_numCols = numCols;
4361
4362 m_table = new wxGridStringTable( m_numRows, m_numCols );
4363 m_table->SetView( this );
4364 m_ownTable = true;
4365 m_selection = new wxGridSelection( this, selmode );
4366
4367 CalcDimensions();
4368
4369 m_created = true;
4370
4371 return m_created;
4372 }
4373
4374 void wxGrid::SetSelectionMode(wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes selmode)
4375 {
4376 wxCHECK_RET( m_created,
4377 wxT("Called wxGrid::SetSelectionMode() before calling CreateGrid()") );
4378
4379 m_selection->SetSelectionMode( selmode );
4380 }
4381
4382 wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes wxGrid::GetSelectionMode() const
4383 {
4384 wxCHECK_MSG( m_created, wxGrid::wxGridSelectCells,
4385 wxT("Called wxGrid::GetSelectionMode() before calling CreateGrid()") );
4386
4387 return m_selection->GetSelectionMode();
4388 }
4389
4390 bool wxGrid::SetTable( wxGridTableBase *table, bool takeOwnership,
4391 wxGrid::wxGridSelectionModes selmode )
4392 {
4393 bool checkSelection = false;
4394 if ( m_created )
4395 {
4396 // stop all processing
4397 m_created = false;
4398
4399 if (m_table)
4400 {
4401 m_table->SetView(0);
4402 if( m_ownTable )
4403 delete m_table;
4404 m_table = NULL;
4405 }
4406
4407 delete m_selection;
4408 m_selection = NULL;
4409
4410 m_ownTable = false;
4411 m_numRows = 0;
4412 m_numCols = 0;
4413 checkSelection = true;
4414
4415 // kill row and column size arrays
4416 m_colWidths.Empty();
4417 m_colRights.Empty();
4418 m_rowHeights.Empty();
4419 m_rowBottoms.Empty();
4420 }
4421
4422 if (table)
4423 {
4424 m_numRows = table->GetNumberRows();
4425 m_numCols = table->GetNumberCols();
4426
4427 m_table = table;
4428 m_table->SetView( this );
4429 m_ownTable = takeOwnership;
4430 m_selection = new wxGridSelection( this, selmode );
4431 if (checkSelection)
4432 {
4433 // If the newly set table is smaller than the
4434 // original one current cell and selection regions
4435 // might be invalid,
4436 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4437 m_currentCellCoords =
4438 wxGridCellCoords(wxMin(m_numRows, m_currentCellCoords.GetRow()),
4439 wxMin(m_numCols, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol()));
4440 if (m_selectingTopLeft.GetRow() >= m_numRows ||
4441 m_selectingTopLeft.GetCol() >= m_numCols)
4442 {
4443 m_selectingTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4444 m_selectingBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4445 }
4446 else
4447 m_selectingBottomRight =
4448 wxGridCellCoords(wxMin(m_numRows,
4449 m_selectingBottomRight.GetRow()),
4450 wxMin(m_numCols,
4451 m_selectingBottomRight.GetCol()));
4452 }
4453 CalcDimensions();
4454
4455 m_created = true;
4456 }
4457
4458 return m_created;
4459 }
4460
4461 void wxGrid::InitVars()
4462 {
4463 m_created = false;
4464
4465 m_cornerLabelWin = NULL;
4466 m_rowLabelWin = NULL;
4467 m_colLabelWin = NULL;
4468 m_gridWin = NULL;
4469
4470 m_table = NULL;
4471 m_ownTable = false;
4472
4473 m_selection = NULL;
4474 m_defaultCellAttr = NULL;
4475 m_typeRegistry = NULL;
4476 m_winCapture = NULL;
4477 }
4478
4479 void wxGrid::Init()
4480 {
4481 m_rowLabelWidth = WXGRID_DEFAULT_ROW_LABEL_WIDTH;
4482 m_colLabelHeight = WXGRID_DEFAULT_COL_LABEL_HEIGHT;
4483
4484 if ( m_rowLabelWin )
4485 {
4486 m_labelBackgroundColour = m_rowLabelWin->GetBackgroundColour();
4487 }
4488 else
4489 {
4490 m_labelBackgroundColour = *wxWHITE;
4491 }
4492
4493 m_labelTextColour = *wxBLACK;
4494
4495 // init attr cache
4496 m_attrCache.row = -1;
4497 m_attrCache.col = -1;
4498 m_attrCache.attr = NULL;
4499
4500 // TODO: something better than this ?
4501 //
4502 m_labelFont = this->GetFont();
4503 m_labelFont.SetWeight( wxBOLD );
4504
4505 m_rowLabelHorizAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4506 m_rowLabelVertAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4507
4508 m_colLabelHorizAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4509 m_colLabelVertAlign = wxALIGN_CENTRE;
4510 m_colLabelTextOrientation = wxHORIZONTAL;
4511
4512 m_defaultColWidth = WXGRID_DEFAULT_COL_WIDTH;
4513 m_defaultRowHeight = m_gridWin->GetCharHeight();
4514
4515 m_minAcceptableColWidth = WXGRID_MIN_COL_WIDTH;
4516 m_minAcceptableRowHeight = WXGRID_MIN_ROW_HEIGHT;
4517
4518 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__) || defined(__WXGTK__) // see also text ctrl sizing in ShowCellEditControl()
4519 m_defaultRowHeight += 8;
4520 #else
4521 m_defaultRowHeight += 4;
4522 #endif
4523
4524 m_gridLineColour = wxColour( 192,192,192 );
4525 m_gridLinesEnabled = true;
4526 m_cellHighlightColour = *wxBLACK;
4527 m_cellHighlightPenWidth = 2;
4528 m_cellHighlightROPenWidth = 1;
4529
4530 m_canDragColMove = false;
4531
4532 m_cursorMode = WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL;
4533 m_winCapture = (wxWindow *)NULL;
4534 m_canDragRowSize = true;
4535 m_canDragColSize = true;
4536 m_canDragGridSize = true;
4537 m_canDragCell = false;
4538 m_dragLastPos = -1;
4539 m_dragRowOrCol = -1;
4540 m_isDragging = false;
4541 m_startDragPos = wxDefaultPosition;
4542 m_nativeColumnLabels = false;
4543
4544 m_waitForSlowClick = false;
4545
4546 m_rowResizeCursor = wxCursor( wxCURSOR_SIZENS );
4547 m_colResizeCursor = wxCursor( wxCURSOR_SIZEWE );
4548
4549 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4550
4551 ClearSelection();
4552
4553 m_selectionBackground = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT);
4554 m_selectionForeground = wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT);
4555
4556 m_editable = true; // default for whole grid
4557
4558 m_inOnKeyDown = false;
4559 m_batchCount = 0;
4560
4561 m_extraWidth =
4562 m_extraHeight = 0;
4563
4564 m_scrollLineX = GRID_SCROLL_LINE_X;
4565 m_scrollLineY = GRID_SCROLL_LINE_Y;
4566 }
4567
4568 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
4569 // the idea is to call these functions only when necessary because they create
4570 // quite big arrays which eat memory mostly unnecessary - in particular, if
4571 // default widths/heights are used for all rows/columns, we may not use these
4572 // arrays at all
4573 //
4574 // with some extra code, it should be possible to only store the widths/heights
4575 // different from default ones (resulting in space savings for huge grids) but
4576 // this is not done currently
4577 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
4578
4579 void wxGrid::InitRowHeights()
4580 {
4581 m_rowHeights.Empty();
4582 m_rowBottoms.Empty();
4583
4584 m_rowHeights.Alloc( m_numRows );
4585 m_rowBottoms.Alloc( m_numRows );
4586
4587 m_rowHeights.Add( m_defaultRowHeight, m_numRows );
4588
4589 int rowBottom = 0;
4590 for ( int i = 0; i < m_numRows; i++ )
4591 {
4592 rowBottom += m_defaultRowHeight;
4593 m_rowBottoms.Add( rowBottom );
4594 }
4595 }
4596
4597 void wxGrid::InitColWidths()
4598 {
4599 m_colWidths.Empty();
4600 m_colRights.Empty();
4601
4602 m_colWidths.Alloc( m_numCols );
4603 m_colRights.Alloc( m_numCols );
4604
4605 m_colWidths.Add( m_defaultColWidth, m_numCols );
4606
4607 int colRight = 0;
4608 for ( int i = 0; i < m_numCols; i++ )
4609 {
4610 colRight = ( GetColPos( i ) + 1 ) * m_defaultColWidth;
4611 m_colRights.Add( colRight );
4612 }
4613 }
4614
4615 int wxGrid::GetColWidth(int col) const
4616 {
4617 return m_colWidths.IsEmpty() ? m_defaultColWidth : m_colWidths[col];
4618 }
4619
4620 int wxGrid::GetColLeft(int col) const
4621 {
4622 return m_colRights.IsEmpty() ? GetColPos( col ) * m_defaultColWidth
4623 : m_colRights[col] - m_colWidths[col];
4624 }
4625
4626 int wxGrid::GetColRight(int col) const
4627 {
4628 return m_colRights.IsEmpty() ? (GetColPos( col ) + 1) * m_defaultColWidth
4629 : m_colRights[col];
4630 }
4631
4632 int wxGrid::GetRowHeight(int row) const
4633 {
4634 return m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() ? m_defaultRowHeight : m_rowHeights[row];
4635 }
4636
4637 int wxGrid::GetRowTop(int row) const
4638 {
4639 return m_rowBottoms.IsEmpty() ? row * m_defaultRowHeight
4640 : m_rowBottoms[row] - m_rowHeights[row];
4641 }
4642
4643 int wxGrid::GetRowBottom(int row) const
4644 {
4645 return m_rowBottoms.IsEmpty() ? (row + 1) * m_defaultRowHeight
4646 : m_rowBottoms[row];
4647 }
4648
4649 void wxGrid::CalcDimensions()
4650 {
4651 // compute the size of the scrollable area
4652 int w = m_numCols > 0 ? GetColRight(GetColAt(m_numCols - 1)) : 0;
4653 int h = m_numRows > 0 ? GetRowBottom(m_numRows - 1) : 0;
4654
4655 w += m_extraWidth;
4656 h += m_extraHeight;
4657
4658 // take into account editor if shown
4659 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
4660 {
4661 int w2, h2;
4662 int r = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
4663 int c = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
4664 int x = GetColLeft(c);
4665 int y = GetRowTop(r);
4666
4667 // how big is the editor
4668 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(r, c);
4669 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, r, c);
4670 editor->GetControl()->GetSize(&w2, &h2);
4671 w2 += x;
4672 h2 += y;
4673 if ( w2 > w )
4674 w = w2;
4675 if ( h2 > h )
4676 h = h2;
4677 editor->DecRef();
4678 attr->DecRef();
4679 }
4680
4681 // preserve (more or less) the previous position
4682 int x, y;
4683 GetViewStart( &x, &y );
4684
4685 // ensure the position is valid for the new scroll ranges
4686 if ( x >= w )
4687 x = wxMax( w - 1, 0 );
4688 if ( y >= h )
4689 y = wxMax( h - 1, 0 );
4690
4691 // do set scrollbar parameters
4692 SetScrollbars( m_scrollLineX, m_scrollLineY,
4693 GetScrollX(w), GetScrollY(h),
4694 x, y,
4695 GetBatchCount() != 0);
4696
4697 // if our OnSize() hadn't been called (it would if we have scrollbars), we
4698 // still must reposition the children
4699 CalcWindowSizes();
4700 }
4701
4702 void wxGrid::CalcWindowSizes()
4703 {
4704 // escape if the window is has not been fully created yet
4705
4706 if ( m_cornerLabelWin == NULL )
4707 return;
4708
4709 int cw, ch;
4710 GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
4711
4712 // this block of code tries to work around the following problem: the grid
4713 // could have been just resized to have enough space to show the full grid
4714 // window contents without the scrollbars, but its client size could be
4715 // not big enough because the grid has the scrollbars right now and so the
4716 // scrollbars would remain even though we don't need them any more
4717 //
4718 // to prevent this from happening, check if we have enough space for
4719 // everything without the scrollbars and explicitly disable them then
4720 wxSize size = GetSize() - GetWindowBorderSize();
4721 if ( size != wxSize(cw, ch) )
4722 {
4723 // check if we have enough space for grid window after accounting for
4724 // the fixed size elements
4725 size.x -= m_rowLabelWidth;
4726 size.y -= m_colLabelHeight;
4727
4728 const wxSize vsize = m_gridWin->GetVirtualSize();
4729
4730 if ( size.x >= vsize.x && size.y >= vsize.y )
4731 {
4732 // yes, we do, so remove the scrollbars and use the new client size
4733 // (which should be the same as full window size - borders now)
4734 SetScrollbars(0, 0, 0, 0);
4735 GetClientSize(&cw, &ch);
4736 }
4737 }
4738
4739 // the grid may be too small to have enough space for the labels yet, don't
4740 // size the windows to negative sizes in this case
4741 int gw = cw - m_rowLabelWidth;
4742 int gh = ch - m_colLabelHeight;
4743 if (gw < 0)
4744 gw = 0;
4745 if (gh < 0)
4746 gh = 0;
4747
4748 if ( m_cornerLabelWin && m_cornerLabelWin->IsShown() )
4749 m_cornerLabelWin->SetSize( 0, 0, m_rowLabelWidth, m_colLabelHeight );
4750
4751 if ( m_colLabelWin && m_colLabelWin->IsShown() )
4752 m_colLabelWin->SetSize( m_rowLabelWidth, 0, gw, m_colLabelHeight );
4753
4754 if ( m_rowLabelWin && m_rowLabelWin->IsShown() )
4755 m_rowLabelWin->SetSize( 0, m_colLabelHeight, m_rowLabelWidth, gh );
4756
4757 if ( m_gridWin && m_gridWin->IsShown() )
4758 m_gridWin->SetSize( m_rowLabelWidth, m_colLabelHeight, gw, gh );
4759 }
4760
4761 // this is called when the grid table sends a message
4762 // to indicate that it has been redimensioned
4763 //
4764 bool wxGrid::Redimension( wxGridTableMessage& msg )
4765 {
4766 int i;
4767 bool result = false;
4768
4769 // Clear the attribute cache as the attribute might refer to a different
4770 // cell than stored in the cache after adding/removing rows/columns.
4771 ClearAttrCache();
4772
4773 // By the same reasoning, the editor should be dismissed if columns are
4774 // added or removed. And for consistency, it should IMHO always be
4775 // removed, not only if the cell "underneath" it actually changes.
4776 // For now, I intentionally do not save the editor's content as the
4777 // cell it might want to save that stuff to might no longer exist.
4778 HideCellEditControl();
4779
4780 #if 0
4781 // if we were using the default widths/heights so far, we must change them
4782 // now
4783 if ( m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
4784 {
4785 InitColWidths();
4786 }
4787
4788 if ( m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
4789 {
4790 InitRowHeights();
4791 }
4792 #endif
4793
4794 switch ( msg.GetId() )
4795 {
4796 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_INSERTED:
4797 {
4798 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
4799 int numRows = msg.GetCommandInt2();
4800
4801 m_numRows += numRows;
4802
4803 if ( !m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
4804 {
4805 m_rowHeights.Insert( m_defaultRowHeight, pos, numRows );
4806 m_rowBottoms.Insert( 0, pos, numRows );
4807
4808 int bottom = 0;
4809 if ( pos > 0 )
4810 bottom = m_rowBottoms[pos - 1];
4811
4812 for ( i = pos; i < m_numRows; i++ )
4813 {
4814 bottom += m_rowHeights[i];
4815 m_rowBottoms[i] = bottom;
4816 }
4817 }
4818
4819 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
4820 {
4821 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
4822 // cell will be undefined...
4823 //
4824 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
4825 }
4826
4827 if ( m_selection )
4828 m_selection->UpdateRows( pos, numRows );
4829 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
4830 if (attrProvider)
4831 attrProvider->UpdateAttrRows( pos, numRows );
4832
4833 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
4834 {
4835 CalcDimensions();
4836 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
4837 }
4838 }
4839 result = true;
4840 break;
4841
4842 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_APPENDED:
4843 {
4844 int numRows = msg.GetCommandInt();
4845 int oldNumRows = m_numRows;
4846 m_numRows += numRows;
4847
4848 if ( !m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
4849 {
4850 m_rowHeights.Add( m_defaultRowHeight, numRows );
4851 m_rowBottoms.Add( 0, numRows );
4852
4853 int bottom = 0;
4854 if ( oldNumRows > 0 )
4855 bottom = m_rowBottoms[oldNumRows - 1];
4856
4857 for ( i = oldNumRows; i < m_numRows; i++ )
4858 {
4859 bottom += m_rowHeights[i];
4860 m_rowBottoms[i] = bottom;
4861 }
4862 }
4863
4864 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
4865 {
4866 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
4867 // cell will be undefined...
4868 //
4869 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
4870 }
4871
4872 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
4873 {
4874 CalcDimensions();
4875 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
4876 }
4877 }
4878 result = true;
4879 break;
4880
4881 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_DELETED:
4882 {
4883 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
4884 int numRows = msg.GetCommandInt2();
4885 m_numRows -= numRows;
4886
4887 if ( !m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
4888 {
4889 m_rowHeights.RemoveAt( pos, numRows );
4890 m_rowBottoms.RemoveAt( pos, numRows );
4891
4892 int h = 0;
4893 for ( i = 0; i < m_numRows; i++ )
4894 {
4895 h += m_rowHeights[i];
4896 m_rowBottoms[i] = h;
4897 }
4898 }
4899
4900 if ( !m_numRows )
4901 {
4902 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
4903 }
4904 else
4905 {
4906 if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() >= m_numRows )
4907 m_currentCellCoords.Set( 0, 0 );
4908 }
4909
4910 if ( m_selection )
4911 m_selection->UpdateRows( pos, -((int)numRows) );
4912 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
4913 if (attrProvider)
4914 {
4915 attrProvider->UpdateAttrRows( pos, -((int)numRows) );
4916
4917 // ifdef'd out following patch from Paul Gammans
4918 #if 0
4919 // No need to touch column attributes, unless we
4920 // removed _all_ rows, in this case, we remove
4921 // all column attributes.
4922 // I hate to do this here, but the
4923 // needed data is not available inside UpdateAttrRows.
4924 if ( !GetNumberRows() )
4925 attrProvider->UpdateAttrCols( 0, -GetNumberCols() );
4926 #endif
4927 }
4928
4929 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
4930 {
4931 CalcDimensions();
4932 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
4933 }
4934 }
4935 result = true;
4936 break;
4937
4938 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_INSERTED:
4939 {
4940 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
4941 int numCols = msg.GetCommandInt2();
4942 m_numCols += numCols;
4943
4944 if ( !m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
4945 {
4946 //Shift the column IDs
4947 int i;
4948 for ( i = 0; i < m_numCols - numCols; i++ )
4949 {
4950 if ( m_colAt[i] >= (int)pos )
4951 m_colAt[i] += numCols;
4952 }
4953
4954 m_colAt.Insert( pos, pos, numCols );
4955
4956 //Set the new columns' positions
4957 for ( i = pos + 1; i < (int)pos + numCols; i++ )
4958 {
4959 m_colAt[i] = i;
4960 }
4961 }
4962
4963 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
4964 {
4965 m_colWidths.Insert( m_defaultColWidth, pos, numCols );
4966 m_colRights.Insert( 0, pos, numCols );
4967
4968 int right = 0;
4969 if ( pos > 0 )
4970 right = m_colRights[GetColAt( pos - 1 )];
4971
4972 int colPos;
4973 for ( colPos = pos; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
4974 {
4975 i = GetColAt( colPos );
4976
4977 right += m_colWidths[i];
4978 m_colRights[i] = right;
4979 }
4980 }
4981
4982 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
4983 {
4984 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
4985 // cell will be undefined...
4986 //
4987 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
4988 }
4989
4990 if ( m_selection )
4991 m_selection->UpdateCols( pos, numCols );
4992 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
4993 if (attrProvider)
4994 attrProvider->UpdateAttrCols( pos, numCols );
4995 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
4996 {
4997 CalcDimensions();
4998 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
4999 }
5000 }
5001 result = true;
5002 break;
5003
5004 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_APPENDED:
5005 {
5006 int numCols = msg.GetCommandInt();
5007 int oldNumCols = m_numCols;
5008 m_numCols += numCols;
5009
5010 if ( !m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
5011 {
5012 m_colAt.Add( 0, numCols );
5013
5014 //Set the new columns' positions
5015 int i;
5016 for ( i = oldNumCols; i < m_numCols; i++ )
5017 {
5018 m_colAt[i] = i;
5019 }
5020 }
5021
5022 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
5023 {
5024 m_colWidths.Add( m_defaultColWidth, numCols );
5025 m_colRights.Add( 0, numCols );
5026
5027 int right = 0;
5028 if ( oldNumCols > 0 )
5029 right = m_colRights[GetColAt( oldNumCols - 1 )];
5030
5031 int colPos;
5032 for ( colPos = oldNumCols; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5033 {
5034 i = GetColAt( colPos );
5035
5036 right += m_colWidths[i];
5037 m_colRights[i] = right;
5038 }
5039 }
5040
5041 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
5042 {
5043 // if we have just inserted cols into an empty grid the current
5044 // cell will be undefined...
5045 //
5046 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
5047 }
5048 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5049 {
5050 CalcDimensions();
5051 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
5052 }
5053 }
5054 result = true;
5055 break;
5056
5057 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_DELETED:
5058 {
5059 size_t pos = msg.GetCommandInt();
5060 int numCols = msg.GetCommandInt2();
5061 m_numCols -= numCols;
5062
5063 if ( !m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
5064 {
5065 int colID = GetColAt( pos );
5066
5067 m_colAt.RemoveAt( pos, numCols );
5068
5069 //Shift the column IDs
5070 int colPos;
5071 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5072 {
5073 if ( m_colAt[colPos] > colID )
5074 m_colAt[colPos] -= numCols;
5075 }
5076 }
5077
5078 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
5079 {
5080 m_colWidths.RemoveAt( pos, numCols );
5081 m_colRights.RemoveAt( pos, numCols );
5082
5083 int w = 0;
5084 int colPos;
5085 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5086 {
5087 i = GetColAt( colPos );
5088
5089 w += m_colWidths[i];
5090 m_colRights[i] = w;
5091 }
5092 }
5093
5094 if ( !m_numCols )
5095 {
5096 m_currentCellCoords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
5097 }
5098 else
5099 {
5100 if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() >= m_numCols )
5101 m_currentCellCoords.Set( 0, 0 );
5102 }
5103
5104 if ( m_selection )
5105 m_selection->UpdateCols( pos, -((int)numCols) );
5106 wxGridCellAttrProvider * attrProvider = m_table->GetAttrProvider();
5107 if (attrProvider)
5108 {
5109 attrProvider->UpdateAttrCols( pos, -((int)numCols) );
5110
5111 // ifdef'd out following patch from Paul Gammans
5112 #if 0
5113 // No need to touch row attributes, unless we
5114 // removed _all_ columns, in this case, we remove
5115 // all row attributes.
5116 // I hate to do this here, but the
5117 // needed data is not available inside UpdateAttrCols.
5118 if ( !GetNumberCols() )
5119 attrProvider->UpdateAttrRows( 0, -GetNumberRows() );
5120 #endif
5121 }
5122
5123 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
5124 {
5125 CalcDimensions();
5126 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
5127 }
5128 }
5129 result = true;
5130 break;
5131 }
5132
5133 if (result && !GetBatchCount() )
5134 m_gridWin->Refresh();
5135
5136 return result;
5137 }
5138
5139 wxArrayInt wxGrid::CalcRowLabelsExposed( const wxRegion& reg ) const
5140 {
5141 wxRegionIterator iter( reg );
5142 wxRect r;
5143
5144 wxArrayInt rowlabels;
5145
5146 int top, bottom;
5147 while ( iter )
5148 {
5149 r = iter.GetRect();
5150
5151 // TODO: remove this when we can...
5152 // There is a bug in wxMotif that gives garbage update
5153 // rectangles if you jump-scroll a long way by clicking the
5154 // scrollbar with middle button. This is a work-around
5155 //
5156 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
5157 int cw, ch;
5158 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5159 if ( r.GetTop() > ch )
5160 r.SetTop( 0 );
5161 r.SetBottom( wxMin( r.GetBottom(), ch ) );
5162 #endif
5163
5164 // logical bounds of update region
5165 //
5166 int dummy;
5167 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, r.GetTop(), &dummy, &top );
5168 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, r.GetBottom(), &dummy, &bottom );
5169
5170 // find the row labels within these bounds
5171 //
5172 int row;
5173 for ( row = internalYToRow(top); row < m_numRows; row++ )
5174 {
5175 if ( GetRowBottom(row) < top )
5176 continue;
5177
5178 if ( GetRowTop(row) > bottom )
5179 break;
5180
5181 rowlabels.Add( row );
5182 }
5183
5184 ++iter;
5185 }
5186
5187 return rowlabels;
5188 }
5189
5190 wxArrayInt wxGrid::CalcColLabelsExposed( const wxRegion& reg ) const
5191 {
5192 wxRegionIterator iter( reg );
5193 wxRect r;
5194
5195 wxArrayInt colLabels;
5196
5197 int left, right;
5198 while ( iter )
5199 {
5200 r = iter.GetRect();
5201
5202 // TODO: remove this when we can...
5203 // There is a bug in wxMotif that gives garbage update
5204 // rectangles if you jump-scroll a long way by clicking the
5205 // scrollbar with middle button. This is a work-around
5206 //
5207 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
5208 int cw, ch;
5209 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5210 if ( r.GetLeft() > cw )
5211 r.SetLeft( 0 );
5212 r.SetRight( wxMin( r.GetRight(), cw ) );
5213 #endif
5214
5215 // logical bounds of update region
5216 //
5217 int dummy;
5218 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), 0, &left, &dummy );
5219 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), 0, &right, &dummy );
5220
5221 // find the cells within these bounds
5222 //
5223 int col;
5224 int colPos;
5225 for ( colPos = GetColPos( internalXToCol(left) ); colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5226 {
5227 col = GetColAt( colPos );
5228
5229 if ( GetColRight(col) < left )
5230 continue;
5231
5232 if ( GetColLeft(col) > right )
5233 break;
5234
5235 colLabels.Add( col );
5236 }
5237
5238 ++iter;
5239 }
5240
5241 return colLabels;
5242 }
5243
5244 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::CalcCellsExposed( const wxRegion& reg ) const
5245 {
5246 wxRegionIterator iter( reg );
5247 wxRect r;
5248
5249 wxGridCellCoordsArray cellsExposed;
5250
5251 int left, top, right, bottom;
5252 while ( iter )
5253 {
5254 r = iter.GetRect();
5255
5256 // TODO: remove this when we can...
5257 // There is a bug in wxMotif that gives garbage update
5258 // rectangles if you jump-scroll a long way by clicking the
5259 // scrollbar with middle button. This is a work-around
5260 //
5261 #if defined(__WXMOTIF__)
5262 int cw, ch;
5263 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5264 if ( r.GetTop() > ch ) r.SetTop( 0 );
5265 if ( r.GetLeft() > cw ) r.SetLeft( 0 );
5266 r.SetRight( wxMin( r.GetRight(), cw ) );
5267 r.SetBottom( wxMin( r.GetBottom(), ch ) );
5268 #endif
5269
5270 // logical bounds of update region
5271 //
5272 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), r.GetTop(), &left, &top );
5273 CalcUnscrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), r.GetBottom(), &right, &bottom );
5274
5275 // find the cells within these bounds
5276 //
5277 int row, col;
5278 for ( row = internalYToRow(top); row < m_numRows; row++ )
5279 {
5280 if ( GetRowBottom(row) <= top )
5281 continue;
5282
5283 if ( GetRowTop(row) > bottom )
5284 break;
5285
5286 int colPos;
5287 for ( colPos = GetColPos( internalXToCol(left) ); colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
5288 {
5289 col = GetColAt( colPos );
5290
5291 if ( GetColRight(col) <= left )
5292 continue;
5293
5294 if ( GetColLeft(col) > right )
5295 break;
5296
5297 cellsExposed.Add( wxGridCellCoords( row, col ) );
5298 }
5299 }
5300
5301 ++iter;
5302 }
5303
5304 return cellsExposed;
5305 }
5306
5307
5308 void wxGrid::ProcessRowLabelMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
5309 {
5310 int x, y, row;
5311 wxPoint pos( event.GetPosition() );
5312 CalcUnscrolledPosition( pos.x, pos.y, &x, &y );
5313
5314 if ( event.Dragging() )
5315 {
5316 if (!m_isDragging)
5317 {
5318 m_isDragging = true;
5319 m_rowLabelWin->CaptureMouse();
5320 }
5321
5322 if ( event.LeftIsDown() )
5323 {
5324 switch ( m_cursorMode )
5325 {
5326 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
5327 {
5328 int cw, ch, left, dummy;
5329 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5330 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &dummy );
5331
5332 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
5333 PrepareDC( dc );
5334 y = wxMax( y,
5335 GetRowTop(m_dragRowOrCol) +
5336 GetRowMinimalHeight(m_dragRowOrCol) );
5337 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
5338 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
5339 {
5340 dc.DrawLine( left, m_dragLastPos, left+cw, m_dragLastPos );
5341 }
5342 dc.DrawLine( left, y, left+cw, y );
5343 m_dragLastPos = y;
5344 }
5345 break;
5346
5347 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_ROW:
5348 {
5349 if ( (row = YToRow( y )) >= 0 )
5350 {
5351 if ( m_selection )
5352 {
5353 m_selection->SelectRow( row,
5354 event.ControlDown(),
5355 event.ShiftDown(),
5356 event.AltDown(),
5357 event.MetaDown() );
5358 }
5359 }
5360 }
5361 break;
5362
5363 // default label to suppress warnings about "enumeration value
5364 // 'xxx' not handled in switch
5365 default:
5366 break;
5367 }
5368 }
5369 return;
5370 }
5371
5372 if ( m_isDragging && (event.Entering() || event.Leaving()) )
5373 return;
5374
5375 if (m_isDragging)
5376 {
5377 if (m_rowLabelWin->HasCapture())
5378 m_rowLabelWin->ReleaseMouse();
5379 m_isDragging = false;
5380 }
5381
5382 // ------------ Entering or leaving the window
5383 //
5384 if ( event.Entering() || event.Leaving() )
5385 {
5386 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_rowLabelWin);
5387 }
5388
5389 // ------------ Left button pressed
5390 //
5391 else if ( event.LeftDown() )
5392 {
5393 // don't send a label click event for a hit on the
5394 // edge of the row label - this is probably the user
5395 // wanting to resize the row
5396 //
5397 if ( YToEdgeOfRow(y) < 0 )
5398 {
5399 row = YToRow(y);
5400 if ( row >= 0 &&
5401 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5402 {
5403 if ( !event.ShiftDown() && !event.CmdDown() )
5404 ClearSelection();
5405 if ( m_selection )
5406 {
5407 if ( event.ShiftDown() )
5408 {
5409 m_selection->SelectBlock( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow(),
5410 0,
5411 row,
5412 GetNumberCols() - 1,
5413 event.ControlDown(),
5414 event.ShiftDown(),
5415 event.AltDown(),
5416 event.MetaDown() );
5417 }
5418 else
5419 {
5420 m_selection->SelectRow( row,
5421 event.ControlDown(),
5422 event.ShiftDown(),
5423 event.AltDown(),
5424 event.MetaDown() );
5425 }
5426 }
5427
5428 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_ROW, m_rowLabelWin);
5429 }
5430 }
5431 else
5432 {
5433 // starting to drag-resize a row
5434 if ( CanDragRowSize() )
5435 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW, m_rowLabelWin);
5436 }
5437 }
5438
5439 // ------------ Left double click
5440 //
5441 else if (event.LeftDClick() )
5442 {
5443 row = YToEdgeOfRow(y);
5444 if ( row < 0 )
5445 {
5446 row = YToRow(y);
5447 if ( row >=0 &&
5448 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5449 {
5450 // no default action at the moment
5451 }
5452 }
5453 else
5454 {
5455 // adjust row height depending on label text
5456 AutoSizeRowLabelSize( row );
5457
5458 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
5459 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5460 }
5461 }
5462
5463 // ------------ Left button released
5464 //
5465 else if ( event.LeftUp() )
5466 {
5467 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW )
5468 {
5469 DoEndDragResizeRow();
5470
5471 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
5472 // default processing in this case
5473 //
5474 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE, m_dragRowOrCol, -1, event );
5475 }
5476
5477 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_rowLabelWin);
5478 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5479 }
5480
5481 // ------------ Right button down
5482 //
5483 else if ( event.RightDown() )
5484 {
5485 row = YToRow(y);
5486 if ( row >=0 &&
5487 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5488 {
5489 // no default action at the moment
5490 }
5491 }
5492
5493 // ------------ Right double click
5494 //
5495 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
5496 {
5497 row = YToRow(y);
5498 if ( row >= 0 &&
5499 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK, row, -1, event ) )
5500 {
5501 // no default action at the moment
5502 }
5503 }
5504
5505 // ------------ No buttons down and mouse moving
5506 //
5507 else if ( event.Moving() )
5508 {
5509 m_dragRowOrCol = YToEdgeOfRow( y );
5510 if ( m_dragRowOrCol >= 0 )
5511 {
5512 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5513 {
5514 // don't capture the mouse yet
5515 if ( CanDragRowSize() )
5516 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW, m_rowLabelWin, false);
5517 }
5518 }
5519 else if ( m_cursorMode != WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5520 {
5521 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_rowLabelWin, false);
5522 }
5523 }
5524 }
5525
5526 void wxGrid::ProcessColLabelMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
5527 {
5528 int x, y, col;
5529 wxPoint pos( event.GetPosition() );
5530 CalcUnscrolledPosition( pos.x, pos.y, &x, &y );
5531
5532 if ( event.Dragging() )
5533 {
5534 if (!m_isDragging)
5535 {
5536 m_isDragging = true;
5537 m_colLabelWin->CaptureMouse();
5538
5539 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL )
5540 m_dragRowOrCol = XToCol( x );
5541 }
5542
5543 if ( event.LeftIsDown() )
5544 {
5545 switch ( m_cursorMode )
5546 {
5547 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
5548 {
5549 int cw, ch, dummy, top;
5550 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5551 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &dummy, &top );
5552
5553 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
5554 PrepareDC( dc );
5555
5556 x = wxMax( x, GetColLeft(m_dragRowOrCol) +
5557 GetColMinimalWidth(m_dragRowOrCol));
5558 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
5559 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
5560 {
5561 dc.DrawLine( m_dragLastPos, top, m_dragLastPos, top + ch );
5562 }
5563 dc.DrawLine( x, top, x, top + ch );
5564 m_dragLastPos = x;
5565 }
5566 break;
5567
5568 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_COL:
5569 {
5570 if ( (col = XToCol( x )) >= 0 )
5571 {
5572 if ( m_selection )
5573 {
5574 m_selection->SelectCol( col,
5575 event.ControlDown(),
5576 event.ShiftDown(),
5577 event.AltDown(),
5578 event.MetaDown() );
5579 }
5580 }
5581 }
5582 break;
5583
5584 case WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL:
5585 {
5586 if ( x < 0 )
5587 m_moveToCol = GetColAt( 0 );
5588 else
5589 m_moveToCol = XToCol( x );
5590
5591 int markerX;
5592
5593 if ( m_moveToCol < 0 )
5594 markerX = GetColRight( GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 ) );
5595 else
5596 markerX = GetColLeft( m_moveToCol );
5597
5598 if ( markerX != m_dragLastPos )
5599 {
5600 wxClientDC dc( m_colLabelWin );
5601
5602 int cw, ch;
5603 m_colLabelWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
5604
5605 markerX++;
5606
5607 //Clean up the last indicator
5608 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
5609 {
5610 wxPen pen( m_colLabelWin->GetBackgroundColour(), 2 );
5611 dc.SetPen(pen);
5612 dc.DrawLine( m_dragLastPos + 1, 0, m_dragLastPos + 1, ch );
5613 dc.SetPen(wxNullPen);
5614
5615 if ( XToCol( m_dragLastPos ) != -1 )
5616 DrawColLabel( dc, XToCol( m_dragLastPos ) );
5617 }
5618
5619 //Moving to the same place? Don't draw a marker
5620 if ( (m_moveToCol == m_dragRowOrCol)
5621 || (GetColPos( m_moveToCol ) == GetColPos( m_dragRowOrCol ) + 1)
5622 || (m_moveToCol < 0 && m_dragRowOrCol == GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 )))
5623 {
5624 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5625 return;
5626 }
5627
5628 //Draw the marker
5629 wxPen pen( *wxBLUE, 2 );
5630 dc.SetPen(pen);
5631
5632 dc.DrawLine( markerX, 0, markerX, ch );
5633
5634 dc.SetPen(wxNullPen);
5635
5636 m_dragLastPos = markerX - 1;
5637 }
5638 }
5639 break;
5640
5641 // default label to suppress warnings about "enumeration value
5642 // 'xxx' not handled in switch
5643 default:
5644 break;
5645 }
5646 }
5647 return;
5648 }
5649
5650 if ( m_isDragging && (event.Entering() || event.Leaving()) )
5651 return;
5652
5653 if (m_isDragging)
5654 {
5655 if (m_colLabelWin->HasCapture())
5656 m_colLabelWin->ReleaseMouse();
5657 m_isDragging = false;
5658 }
5659
5660 // ------------ Entering or leaving the window
5661 //
5662 if ( event.Entering() || event.Leaving() )
5663 {
5664 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
5665 }
5666
5667 // ------------ Left button pressed
5668 //
5669 else if ( event.LeftDown() )
5670 {
5671 // don't send a label click event for a hit on the
5672 // edge of the col label - this is probably the user
5673 // wanting to resize the col
5674 //
5675 if ( XToEdgeOfCol(x) < 0 )
5676 {
5677 col = XToCol(x);
5678 if ( col >= 0 &&
5679 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK, -1, col, event ) )
5680 {
5681 if ( m_canDragColMove )
5682 {
5683 //Show button as pressed
5684 wxClientDC dc( m_colLabelWin );
5685 int colLeft = GetColLeft( col );
5686 int colRight = GetColRight( col ) - 1;
5687 dc.SetPen( wxPen( m_colLabelWin->GetBackgroundColour(), 1 ) );
5688 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colLeft, m_colLabelHeight-1 );
5689 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colRight, 1 );
5690
5691 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL, m_colLabelWin);
5692 }
5693 else
5694 {
5695 if ( !event.ShiftDown() && !event.CmdDown() )
5696 ClearSelection();
5697 if ( m_selection )
5698 {
5699 if ( event.ShiftDown() )
5700 {
5701 m_selection->SelectBlock( 0,
5702 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol(),
5703 GetNumberRows() - 1, col,
5704 event.ControlDown(),
5705 event.ShiftDown(),
5706 event.AltDown(),
5707 event.MetaDown() );
5708 }
5709 else
5710 {
5711 m_selection->SelectCol( col,
5712 event.ControlDown(),
5713 event.ShiftDown(),
5714 event.AltDown(),
5715 event.MetaDown() );
5716 }
5717 }
5718
5719 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_COL, m_colLabelWin);
5720 }
5721 }
5722 }
5723 else
5724 {
5725 // starting to drag-resize a col
5726 //
5727 if ( CanDragColSize() )
5728 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL, m_colLabelWin);
5729 }
5730 }
5731
5732 // ------------ Left double click
5733 //
5734 if ( event.LeftDClick() )
5735 {
5736 col = XToEdgeOfCol(x);
5737 if ( col < 0 )
5738 {
5739 col = XToCol(x);
5740 if ( col >= 0 &&
5741 ! SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK, -1, col, event ) )
5742 {
5743 // no default action at the moment
5744 }
5745 }
5746 else
5747 {
5748 // adjust column width depending on label text
5749 AutoSizeColLabelSize( col );
5750
5751 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
5752 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5753 }
5754 }
5755
5756 // ------------ Left button released
5757 //
5758 else if ( event.LeftUp() )
5759 {
5760 switch ( m_cursorMode )
5761 {
5762 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
5763 DoEndDragResizeCol();
5764
5765 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
5766 // default processing in this case
5767 //
5768 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE, -1, m_dragRowOrCol, event );
5769 break;
5770
5771 case WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL:
5772 DoEndDragMoveCol();
5773
5774 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_COL_MOVE, -1, m_dragRowOrCol, event );
5775 break;
5776
5777 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_COL:
5778 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL:
5779 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
5780 case WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_ROW:
5781 // nothing to do (?)
5782 break;
5783 }
5784
5785 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin);
5786 m_dragLastPos = -1;
5787 }
5788
5789 // ------------ Right button down
5790 //
5791 else if ( event.RightDown() )
5792 {
5793 col = XToCol(x);
5794 if ( col >= 0 &&
5795 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK, -1, col, event ) )
5796 {
5797 // no default action at the moment
5798 }
5799 }
5800
5801 // ------------ Right double click
5802 //
5803 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
5804 {
5805 col = XToCol(x);
5806 if ( col >= 0 &&
5807 !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK, -1, col, event ) )
5808 {
5809 // no default action at the moment
5810 }
5811 }
5812
5813 // ------------ No buttons down and mouse moving
5814 //
5815 else if ( event.Moving() )
5816 {
5817 m_dragRowOrCol = XToEdgeOfCol( x );
5818 if ( m_dragRowOrCol >= 0 )
5819 {
5820 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5821 {
5822 // don't capture the cursor yet
5823 if ( CanDragColSize() )
5824 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL, m_colLabelWin, false);
5825 }
5826 }
5827 else if ( m_cursorMode != WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5828 {
5829 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL, m_colLabelWin, false);
5830 }
5831 }
5832 }
5833
5834 void wxGrid::ProcessCornerLabelMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
5835 {
5836 if ( event.LeftDown() )
5837 {
5838 // indicate corner label by having both row and
5839 // col args == -1
5840 //
5841 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK, -1, -1, event ) )
5842 {
5843 SelectAll();
5844 }
5845 }
5846 else if ( event.LeftDClick() )
5847 {
5848 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK, -1, -1, event );
5849 }
5850 else if ( event.RightDown() )
5851 {
5852 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK, -1, -1, event ) )
5853 {
5854 // no default action at the moment
5855 }
5856 }
5857 else if ( event.RightDClick() )
5858 {
5859 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK, -1, -1, event ) )
5860 {
5861 // no default action at the moment
5862 }
5863 }
5864 }
5865
5866 void wxGrid::CancelMouseCapture()
5867 {
5868 // cancel operation currently in progress, whatever it is
5869 if ( m_winCapture )
5870 {
5871 m_isDragging = false;
5872 m_cursorMode = WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL;
5873 m_winCapture->SetCursor( *wxSTANDARD_CURSOR );
5874 m_winCapture = NULL;
5875
5876 // remove traces of whatever we drew on screen
5877 Refresh();
5878 }
5879 }
5880
5881 void wxGrid::ChangeCursorMode(CursorMode mode,
5882 wxWindow *win,
5883 bool captureMouse)
5884 {
5885 #ifdef __WXDEBUG__
5886 static const wxChar *cursorModes[] =
5887 {
5888 _T("SELECT_CELL"),
5889 _T("RESIZE_ROW"),
5890 _T("RESIZE_COL"),
5891 _T("SELECT_ROW"),
5892 _T("SELECT_COL"),
5893 _T("MOVE_COL"),
5894 };
5895
5896 wxLogTrace(_T("grid"),
5897 _T("wxGrid cursor mode (mouse capture for %s): %s -> %s"),
5898 win == m_colLabelWin ? _T("colLabelWin")
5899 : win ? _T("rowLabelWin")
5900 : _T("gridWin"),
5901 cursorModes[m_cursorMode], cursorModes[mode]);
5902 #endif
5903
5904 if ( mode == m_cursorMode &&
5905 win == m_winCapture &&
5906 captureMouse == (m_winCapture != NULL))
5907 return;
5908
5909 if ( !win )
5910 {
5911 // by default use the grid itself
5912 win = m_gridWin;
5913 }
5914
5915 if ( m_winCapture )
5916 {
5917 if (m_winCapture->HasCapture())
5918 m_winCapture->ReleaseMouse();
5919 m_winCapture = (wxWindow *)NULL;
5920 }
5921
5922 m_cursorMode = mode;
5923
5924 switch ( m_cursorMode )
5925 {
5926 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW:
5927 win->SetCursor( m_rowResizeCursor );
5928 break;
5929
5930 case WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL:
5931 win->SetCursor( m_colResizeCursor );
5932 break;
5933
5934 case WXGRID_CURSOR_MOVE_COL:
5935 win->SetCursor( wxCursor(wxCURSOR_HAND) );
5936 break;
5937
5938 default:
5939 win->SetCursor( *wxSTANDARD_CURSOR );
5940 break;
5941 }
5942
5943 // we need to capture mouse when resizing
5944 bool resize = m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW ||
5945 m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL;
5946
5947 if ( captureMouse && resize )
5948 {
5949 win->CaptureMouse();
5950 m_winCapture = win;
5951 }
5952 }
5953
5954 void wxGrid::ProcessGridCellMouseEvent( wxMouseEvent& event )
5955 {
5956 int x, y;
5957 wxPoint pos( event.GetPosition() );
5958 CalcUnscrolledPosition( pos.x, pos.y, &x, &y );
5959
5960 wxGridCellCoords coords;
5961 XYToCell( x, y, coords );
5962
5963 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
5964 bool isFirstDrag = !m_isDragging;
5965 GetCellSize( coords.GetRow(), coords.GetCol(), &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
5966 if ((cell_rows < 0) || (cell_cols < 0))
5967 {
5968 coords.SetRow(coords.GetRow() + cell_rows);
5969 coords.SetCol(coords.GetCol() + cell_cols);
5970 }
5971
5972 if ( event.Dragging() )
5973 {
5974 //wxLogDebug("pos(%d, %d) coords(%d, %d)", pos.x, pos.y, coords.GetRow(), coords.GetCol());
5975
5976 // Don't start doing anything until the mouse has been dragged at
5977 // least 3 pixels in any direction...
5978 if (! m_isDragging)
5979 {
5980 if (m_startDragPos == wxDefaultPosition)
5981 {
5982 m_startDragPos = pos;
5983 return;
5984 }
5985 if (abs(m_startDragPos.x - pos.x) < 4 && abs(m_startDragPos.y - pos.y) < 4)
5986 return;
5987 }
5988
5989 m_isDragging = true;
5990 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
5991 {
5992 // Hide the edit control, so it
5993 // won't interfere with drag-shrinking.
5994 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
5995 {
5996 HideCellEditControl();
5997 SaveEditControlValue();
5998 }
5999
6000 if ( coords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6001 {
6002 if ( event.CmdDown() )
6003 {
6004 if ( m_selectingKeyboard == wxGridNoCellCoords)
6005 m_selectingKeyboard = coords;
6006 HighlightBlock( m_selectingKeyboard, coords );
6007 }
6008 else if ( CanDragCell() )
6009 {
6010 if ( isFirstDrag )
6011 {
6012 if ( m_selectingKeyboard == wxGridNoCellCoords)
6013 m_selectingKeyboard = coords;
6014
6015 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_CELL_BEGIN_DRAG,
6016 coords.GetRow(),
6017 coords.GetCol(),
6018 event );
6019 return;
6020 }
6021 }
6022 else
6023 {
6024 if ( !IsSelection() )
6025 {
6026 HighlightBlock( coords, coords );
6027 }
6028 else
6029 {
6030 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, coords );
6031 }
6032 }
6033
6034 if (! IsVisible(coords))
6035 {
6036 MakeCellVisible(coords);
6037 // TODO: need to introduce a delay or something here. The
6038 // scrolling is way to fast, at least on MSW - also on GTK.
6039 }
6040 }
6041 // Have we captured the mouse yet?
6042 if (! m_winCapture)
6043 {
6044 m_winCapture = m_gridWin;
6045 m_winCapture->CaptureMouse();
6046 }
6047
6048
6049 }
6050 else if ( event.LeftIsDown() &&
6051 m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW )
6052 {
6053 int cw, ch, left, dummy;
6054 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
6055 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &dummy );
6056
6057 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
6058 PrepareDC( dc );
6059 y = wxMax( y, GetRowTop(m_dragRowOrCol) +
6060 GetRowMinimalHeight(m_dragRowOrCol) );
6061 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
6062 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
6063 {
6064 dc.DrawLine( left, m_dragLastPos, left+cw, m_dragLastPos );
6065 }
6066 dc.DrawLine( left, y, left+cw, y );
6067 m_dragLastPos = y;
6068 }
6069 else if ( event.LeftIsDown() &&
6070 m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL )
6071 {
6072 int cw, ch, dummy, top;
6073 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
6074 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &dummy, &top );
6075
6076 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
6077 PrepareDC( dc );
6078 x = wxMax( x, GetColLeft(m_dragRowOrCol) +
6079 GetColMinimalWidth(m_dragRowOrCol) );
6080 dc.SetLogicalFunction(wxINVERT);
6081 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
6082 {
6083 dc.DrawLine( m_dragLastPos, top, m_dragLastPos, top + ch );
6084 }
6085 dc.DrawLine( x, top, x, top + ch );
6086 m_dragLastPos = x;
6087 }
6088
6089 return;
6090 }
6091
6092 m_isDragging = false;
6093 m_startDragPos = wxDefaultPosition;
6094
6095 // VZ: if we do this, the mode is reset to WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL
6096 // immediately after it becomes WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW/COL under
6097 // wxGTK
6098 #if 0
6099 if ( event.Entering() || event.Leaving() )
6100 {
6101 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6102 m_gridWin->SetCursor( *wxSTANDARD_CURSOR );
6103 }
6104 else
6105 #endif // 0
6106
6107 // ------------ Left button pressed
6108 //
6109 if ( event.LeftDown() && coords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6110 {
6111 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_CLICK,
6112 coords.GetRow(),
6113 coords.GetCol(),
6114 event ) )
6115 {
6116 if ( !event.CmdDown() )
6117 ClearSelection();
6118 if ( event.ShiftDown() )
6119 {
6120 if ( m_selection )
6121 {
6122 m_selection->SelectBlock( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow(),
6123 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol(),
6124 coords.GetRow(),
6125 coords.GetCol(),
6126 event.ControlDown(),
6127 event.ShiftDown(),
6128 event.AltDown(),
6129 event.MetaDown() );
6130 }
6131 }
6132 else if ( XToEdgeOfCol(x) < 0 &&
6133 YToEdgeOfRow(y) < 0 )
6134 {
6135 DisableCellEditControl();
6136 MakeCellVisible( coords );
6137
6138 if ( event.CmdDown() )
6139 {
6140 if ( m_selection )
6141 {
6142 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection( coords.GetRow(),
6143 coords.GetCol(),
6144 event.ControlDown(),
6145 event.ShiftDown(),
6146 event.AltDown(),
6147 event.MetaDown() );
6148 }
6149 m_selectingTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6150 m_selectingBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6151 m_selectingKeyboard = coords;
6152 }
6153 else
6154 {
6155 m_waitForSlowClick = m_currentCellCoords == coords && coords != wxGridNoCellCoords;
6156 SetCurrentCell( coords );
6157 if ( m_selection )
6158 {
6159 if ( m_selection->GetSelectionMode() !=
6160 wxGrid::wxGridSelectCells )
6161 {
6162 HighlightBlock( coords, coords );
6163 }
6164 }
6165 }
6166 }
6167 }
6168 }
6169
6170 // ------------ Left double click
6171 //
6172 else if ( event.LeftDClick() && coords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6173 {
6174 DisableCellEditControl();
6175
6176 if ( XToEdgeOfCol(x) < 0 && YToEdgeOfRow(y) < 0 )
6177 {
6178 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_CELL_LEFT_DCLICK,
6179 coords.GetRow(),
6180 coords.GetCol(),
6181 event ) )
6182 {
6183 // we want double click to select a cell and start editing
6184 // (i.e. to behave in same way as sequence of two slow clicks):
6185 m_waitForSlowClick = true;
6186 }
6187 }
6188 }
6189
6190 // ------------ Left button released
6191 //
6192 else if ( event.LeftUp() )
6193 {
6194 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6195 {
6196 if (m_winCapture)
6197 {
6198 if (m_winCapture->HasCapture())
6199 m_winCapture->ReleaseMouse();
6200 m_winCapture = NULL;
6201 }
6202
6203 if ( coords == m_currentCellCoords && m_waitForSlowClick && CanEnableCellControl() )
6204 {
6205 ClearSelection();
6206 EnableCellEditControl();
6207
6208 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(coords);
6209 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, coords.GetRow(), coords.GetCol());
6210 editor->StartingClick();
6211 editor->DecRef();
6212 attr->DecRef();
6213
6214 m_waitForSlowClick = false;
6215 }
6216 else if ( m_selectingTopLeft != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
6217 m_selectingBottomRight != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6218 {
6219 if ( m_selection )
6220 {
6221 m_selection->SelectBlock( m_selectingTopLeft.GetRow(),
6222 m_selectingTopLeft.GetCol(),
6223 m_selectingBottomRight.GetRow(),
6224 m_selectingBottomRight.GetCol(),
6225 event.ControlDown(),
6226 event.ShiftDown(),
6227 event.AltDown(),
6228 event.MetaDown() );
6229 }
6230
6231 m_selectingTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6232 m_selectingBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
6233
6234 // Show the edit control, if it has been hidden for
6235 // drag-shrinking.
6236 ShowCellEditControl();
6237 }
6238 }
6239 else if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW )
6240 {
6241 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6242 DoEndDragResizeRow();
6243
6244 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
6245 // default processing in this case
6246 //
6247 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE, m_dragRowOrCol, -1, event );
6248 }
6249 else if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL )
6250 {
6251 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6252 DoEndDragResizeCol();
6253
6254 // Note: we are ending the event *after* doing
6255 // default processing in this case
6256 //
6257 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE, -1, m_dragRowOrCol, event );
6258 }
6259
6260 m_dragLastPos = -1;
6261 }
6262
6263 // ------------ Right button down
6264 //
6265 else if ( event.RightDown() && coords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6266 {
6267 DisableCellEditControl();
6268 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_CLICK,
6269 coords.GetRow(),
6270 coords.GetCol(),
6271 event ) )
6272 {
6273 // no default action at the moment
6274 }
6275 }
6276
6277 // ------------ Right double click
6278 //
6279 else if ( event.RightDClick() && coords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
6280 {
6281 DisableCellEditControl();
6282 if ( !SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_CELL_RIGHT_DCLICK,
6283 coords.GetRow(),
6284 coords.GetCol(),
6285 event ) )
6286 {
6287 // no default action at the moment
6288 }
6289 }
6290
6291 // ------------ Moving and no button action
6292 //
6293 else if ( event.Moving() && !event.IsButton() )
6294 {
6295 if ( coords.GetRow() < 0 || coords.GetCol() < 0 )
6296 {
6297 // out of grid cell area
6298 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6299 return;
6300 }
6301
6302 int dragRow = YToEdgeOfRow( y );
6303 int dragCol = XToEdgeOfCol( x );
6304
6305 // Dragging on the corner of a cell to resize in both
6306 // directions is not implemented yet...
6307 //
6308 if ( dragRow >= 0 && dragCol >= 0 )
6309 {
6310 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6311 return;
6312 }
6313
6314 if ( dragRow >= 0 )
6315 {
6316 m_dragRowOrCol = dragRow;
6317
6318 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6319 {
6320 if ( CanDragRowSize() && CanDragGridSize() )
6321 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_ROW, NULL, false);
6322 }
6323 }
6324 else if ( dragCol >= 0 )
6325 {
6326 m_dragRowOrCol = dragCol;
6327
6328 if ( m_cursorMode == WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6329 {
6330 if ( CanDragColSize() && CanDragGridSize() )
6331 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_RESIZE_COL, NULL, false);
6332 }
6333 }
6334 else // Neither on a row or col edge
6335 {
6336 if ( m_cursorMode != WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL )
6337 {
6338 ChangeCursorMode(WXGRID_CURSOR_SELECT_CELL);
6339 }
6340 }
6341 }
6342 }
6343
6344 void wxGrid::DoEndDragResizeRow()
6345 {
6346 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
6347 {
6348 // erase the last line and resize the row
6349 //
6350 int cw, ch, left, dummy;
6351 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
6352 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &dummy );
6353
6354 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
6355 PrepareDC( dc );
6356 dc.SetLogicalFunction( wxINVERT );
6357 dc.DrawLine( left, m_dragLastPos, left + cw, m_dragLastPos );
6358 HideCellEditControl();
6359 SaveEditControlValue();
6360
6361 int rowTop = GetRowTop(m_dragRowOrCol);
6362 SetRowSize( m_dragRowOrCol,
6363 wxMax( m_dragLastPos - rowTop, m_minAcceptableRowHeight ) );
6364
6365 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
6366 {
6367 // Only needed to get the correct rect.y:
6368 wxRect rect ( CellToRect( m_dragRowOrCol, 0 ) );
6369 rect.x = 0;
6370 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &dummy, &rect.y);
6371 rect.width = m_rowLabelWidth;
6372 rect.height = ch - rect.y;
6373 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
6374 rect.width = cw;
6375
6376 // if there is a multicell block, paint all of it
6377 if (m_table)
6378 {
6379 int i, cell_rows, cell_cols, subtract_rows = 0;
6380 int leftCol = XToCol(left);
6381 int rightCol = internalXToCol(left + cw);
6382 if (leftCol >= 0)
6383 {
6384 for (i=leftCol; i<rightCol; i++)
6385 {
6386 GetCellSize(m_dragRowOrCol, i, &cell_rows, &cell_cols);
6387 if (cell_rows < subtract_rows)
6388 subtract_rows = cell_rows;
6389 }
6390 rect.y = GetRowTop(m_dragRowOrCol + subtract_rows);
6391 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &dummy, &rect.y);
6392 rect.height = ch - rect.y;
6393 }
6394 }
6395 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
6396 }
6397
6398 ShowCellEditControl();
6399 }
6400 }
6401
6402
6403 void wxGrid::DoEndDragResizeCol()
6404 {
6405 if ( m_dragLastPos >= 0 )
6406 {
6407 // erase the last line and resize the col
6408 //
6409 int cw, ch, dummy, top;
6410 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
6411 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &dummy, &top );
6412
6413 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
6414 PrepareDC( dc );
6415 dc.SetLogicalFunction( wxINVERT );
6416 dc.DrawLine( m_dragLastPos, top, m_dragLastPos, top + ch );
6417 HideCellEditControl();
6418 SaveEditControlValue();
6419
6420 int colLeft = GetColLeft(m_dragRowOrCol);
6421 SetColSize( m_dragRowOrCol,
6422 wxMax( m_dragLastPos - colLeft,
6423 GetColMinimalWidth(m_dragRowOrCol) ) );
6424
6425 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
6426 {
6427 // Only needed to get the correct rect.x:
6428 wxRect rect ( CellToRect( 0, m_dragRowOrCol ) );
6429 rect.y = 0;
6430 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, 0, &rect.x, &dummy);
6431 rect.width = cw - rect.x;
6432 rect.height = m_colLabelHeight;
6433 m_colLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
6434 rect.height = ch;
6435
6436 // if there is a multicell block, paint all of it
6437 if (m_table)
6438 {
6439 int i, cell_rows, cell_cols, subtract_cols = 0;
6440 int topRow = YToRow(top);
6441 int bottomRow = internalYToRow(top + cw);
6442 if (topRow >= 0)
6443 {
6444 for (i=topRow; i<bottomRow; i++)
6445 {
6446 GetCellSize(i, m_dragRowOrCol, &cell_rows, &cell_cols);
6447 if (cell_cols < subtract_cols)
6448 subtract_cols = cell_cols;
6449 }
6450
6451 rect.x = GetColLeft(m_dragRowOrCol + subtract_cols);
6452 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, 0, &rect.x, &dummy);
6453 rect.width = cw - rect.x;
6454 }
6455 }
6456
6457 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
6458 }
6459
6460 ShowCellEditControl();
6461 }
6462 }
6463
6464 void wxGrid::DoEndDragMoveCol()
6465 {
6466 //The user clicked on the column but didn't actually drag
6467 if ( m_dragLastPos < 0 )
6468 {
6469 m_colLabelWin->Refresh(); //Do this to "unpress" the column
6470 return;
6471 }
6472
6473 int newPos;
6474 if ( m_moveToCol == -1 )
6475 newPos = m_numCols - 1;
6476 else
6477 {
6478 newPos = GetColPos( m_moveToCol );
6479 if ( newPos > GetColPos( m_dragRowOrCol ) )
6480 newPos--;
6481 }
6482
6483 SetColPos( m_dragRowOrCol, newPos );
6484 }
6485
6486 void wxGrid::SetColPos( int colID, int newPos )
6487 {
6488 if ( m_colAt.IsEmpty() )
6489 {
6490 m_colAt.Alloc( m_numCols );
6491
6492 int i;
6493 for ( i = 0; i < m_numCols; i++ )
6494 {
6495 m_colAt.Add( i );
6496 }
6497 }
6498
6499 int oldPos = GetColPos( colID );
6500
6501 //Reshuffle the m_colAt array
6502 if ( newPos > oldPos )
6503 {
6504 int i;
6505 for ( i = oldPos; i < newPos; i++ )
6506 {
6507 m_colAt[i] = m_colAt[i+1];
6508 }
6509 }
6510 else
6511 {
6512 int i;
6513 for ( i = oldPos; i > newPos; i-- )
6514 {
6515 m_colAt[i] = m_colAt[i-1];
6516 }
6517 }
6518
6519 m_colAt[newPos] = colID;
6520
6521 //Recalculate the column rights
6522 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
6523 {
6524 int colRight = 0;
6525 int colPos;
6526 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
6527 {
6528 int colID = GetColAt( colPos );
6529
6530 colRight += m_colWidths[colID];
6531 m_colRights[colID] = colRight;
6532 }
6533 }
6534
6535 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
6536 m_gridWin->Refresh();
6537 }
6538
6539
6540
6541 void wxGrid::EnableDragColMove( bool enable )
6542 {
6543 if ( m_canDragColMove == enable )
6544 return;
6545
6546 m_canDragColMove = enable;
6547
6548 if ( !m_canDragColMove )
6549 {
6550 m_colAt.Clear();
6551
6552 //Recalculate the column rights
6553 if ( !m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
6554 {
6555 int colRight = 0;
6556 int colPos;
6557 for ( colPos = 0; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
6558 {
6559 colRight += m_colWidths[colPos];
6560 m_colRights[colPos] = colRight;
6561 }
6562 }
6563
6564 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
6565 m_gridWin->Refresh();
6566 }
6567 }
6568
6569
6570 //
6571 // ------ interaction with data model
6572 //
6573 bool wxGrid::ProcessTableMessage( wxGridTableMessage& msg )
6574 {
6575 switch ( msg.GetId() )
6576 {
6577 case wxGRIDTABLE_REQUEST_VIEW_GET_VALUES:
6578 return GetModelValues();
6579
6580 case wxGRIDTABLE_REQUEST_VIEW_SEND_VALUES:
6581 return SetModelValues();
6582
6583 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_INSERTED:
6584 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_APPENDED:
6585 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_ROWS_DELETED:
6586 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_INSERTED:
6587 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_APPENDED:
6588 case wxGRIDTABLE_NOTIFY_COLS_DELETED:
6589 return Redimension( msg );
6590
6591 default:
6592 return false;
6593 }
6594 }
6595
6596 // The behaviour of this function depends on the grid table class
6597 // Clear() function. For the default wxGridStringTable class the
6598 // behavious is to replace all cell contents with wxEmptyString but
6599 // not to change the number of rows or cols.
6600 //
6601 void wxGrid::ClearGrid()
6602 {
6603 if ( m_table )
6604 {
6605 if (IsCellEditControlEnabled())
6606 DisableCellEditControl();
6607
6608 m_table->Clear();
6609 if (!GetBatchCount())
6610 m_gridWin->Refresh();
6611 }
6612 }
6613
6614 bool wxGrid::InsertRows( int pos, int numRows, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6615 {
6616 // TODO: something with updateLabels flag
6617
6618 if ( !m_created )
6619 {
6620 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called wxGrid::InsertRows() before calling CreateGrid()") );
6621 return false;
6622 }
6623
6624 if ( m_table )
6625 {
6626 if (IsCellEditControlEnabled())
6627 DisableCellEditControl();
6628
6629 bool done = m_table->InsertRows( pos, numRows );
6630 return done;
6631
6632 // the table will have sent the results of the insert row
6633 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6634 }
6635
6636 return false;
6637 }
6638
6639 bool wxGrid::AppendRows( int numRows, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6640 {
6641 // TODO: something with updateLabels flag
6642
6643 if ( !m_created )
6644 {
6645 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called wxGrid::AppendRows() before calling CreateGrid()") );
6646 return false;
6647 }
6648
6649 if ( m_table )
6650 {
6651 bool done = m_table && m_table->AppendRows( numRows );
6652 return done;
6653
6654 // the table will have sent the results of the append row
6655 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6656 }
6657
6658 return false;
6659 }
6660
6661 bool wxGrid::DeleteRows( int pos, int numRows, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6662 {
6663 // TODO: something with updateLabels flag
6664
6665 if ( !m_created )
6666 {
6667 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called wxGrid::DeleteRows() before calling CreateGrid()") );
6668 return false;
6669 }
6670
6671 if ( m_table )
6672 {
6673 if (IsCellEditControlEnabled())
6674 DisableCellEditControl();
6675
6676 bool done = m_table->DeleteRows( pos, numRows );
6677 return done;
6678 // the table will have sent the results of the delete row
6679 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6680 }
6681
6682 return false;
6683 }
6684
6685 bool wxGrid::InsertCols( int pos, int numCols, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6686 {
6687 // TODO: something with updateLabels flag
6688
6689 if ( !m_created )
6690 {
6691 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called wxGrid::InsertCols() before calling CreateGrid()") );
6692 return false;
6693 }
6694
6695 if ( m_table )
6696 {
6697 if (IsCellEditControlEnabled())
6698 DisableCellEditControl();
6699
6700 bool done = m_table->InsertCols( pos, numCols );
6701 return done;
6702 // the table will have sent the results of the insert col
6703 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6704 }
6705
6706 return false;
6707 }
6708
6709 bool wxGrid::AppendCols( int numCols, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6710 {
6711 // TODO: something with updateLabels flag
6712
6713 if ( !m_created )
6714 {
6715 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called wxGrid::AppendCols() before calling CreateGrid()") );
6716 return false;
6717 }
6718
6719 if ( m_table )
6720 {
6721 bool done = m_table->AppendCols( numCols );
6722 return done;
6723 // the table will have sent the results of the append col
6724 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6725 }
6726
6727 return false;
6728 }
6729
6730 bool wxGrid::DeleteCols( int pos, int numCols, bool WXUNUSED(updateLabels) )
6731 {
6732 // TODO: something with updateLabels flag
6733
6734 if ( !m_created )
6735 {
6736 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("Called wxGrid::DeleteCols() before calling CreateGrid()") );
6737 return false;
6738 }
6739
6740 if ( m_table )
6741 {
6742 if (IsCellEditControlEnabled())
6743 DisableCellEditControl();
6744
6745 bool done = m_table->DeleteCols( pos, numCols );
6746 return done;
6747 // the table will have sent the results of the delete col
6748 // operation to this view object as a grid table message
6749 }
6750
6751 return false;
6752 }
6753
6754 //
6755 // ----- event handlers
6756 //
6757
6758 // Generate a grid event based on a mouse event and
6759 // return the result of ProcessEvent()
6760 //
6761 int wxGrid::SendEvent( const wxEventType type,
6762 int row, int col,
6763 wxMouseEvent& mouseEv )
6764 {
6765 bool claimed, vetoed;
6766
6767 if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE || type == wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE )
6768 {
6769 int rowOrCol = (row == -1 ? col : row);
6770
6771 wxGridSizeEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6772 type,
6773 this,
6774 rowOrCol,
6775 mouseEv.GetX() + GetRowLabelSize(),
6776 mouseEv.GetY() + GetColLabelSize(),
6777 mouseEv.ControlDown(),
6778 mouseEv.ShiftDown(),
6779 mouseEv.AltDown(),
6780 mouseEv.MetaDown() );
6781
6782 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6783 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6784 }
6785 else if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_RANGE_SELECT )
6786 {
6787 // Right now, it should _never_ end up here!
6788 wxGridRangeSelectEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6789 type,
6790 this,
6791 m_selectingTopLeft,
6792 m_selectingBottomRight,
6793 true,
6794 mouseEv.ControlDown(),
6795 mouseEv.ShiftDown(),
6796 mouseEv.AltDown(),
6797 mouseEv.MetaDown() );
6798
6799 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6800 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6801 }
6802 else if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_CLICK ||
6803 type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_LEFT_DCLICK ||
6804 type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_CLICK ||
6805 type == wxEVT_GRID_LABEL_RIGHT_DCLICK )
6806 {
6807 wxPoint pos = mouseEv.GetPosition();
6808
6809 if ( mouseEv.GetEventObject() == GetGridRowLabelWindow() )
6810 pos.y += GetColLabelSize();
6811 if ( mouseEv.GetEventObject() == GetGridColLabelWindow() )
6812 pos.x += GetRowLabelSize();
6813
6814 wxGridEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6815 type,
6816 this,
6817 row, col,
6818 pos.x,
6819 pos.y,
6820 false,
6821 mouseEv.ControlDown(),
6822 mouseEv.ShiftDown(),
6823 mouseEv.AltDown(),
6824 mouseEv.MetaDown() );
6825 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6826 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6827 }
6828 else
6829 {
6830 wxGridEvent gridEvt( GetId(),
6831 type,
6832 this,
6833 row, col,
6834 mouseEv.GetX() + GetRowLabelSize(),
6835 mouseEv.GetY() + GetColLabelSize(),
6836 false,
6837 mouseEv.ControlDown(),
6838 mouseEv.ShiftDown(),
6839 mouseEv.AltDown(),
6840 mouseEv.MetaDown() );
6841 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6842 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6843 }
6844
6845 // A Veto'd event may not be `claimed' so test this first
6846 if (vetoed)
6847 return -1;
6848
6849 return claimed ? 1 : 0;
6850 }
6851
6852 // Generate a grid event of specified type and return the result
6853 // of ProcessEvent().
6854 //
6855 int wxGrid::SendEvent( const wxEventType type,
6856 int row, int col )
6857 {
6858 bool claimed, vetoed;
6859
6860 if ( type == wxEVT_GRID_ROW_SIZE || type == wxEVT_GRID_COL_SIZE )
6861 {
6862 int rowOrCol = (row == -1 ? col : row);
6863
6864 wxGridSizeEvent gridEvt( GetId(), type, this, rowOrCol );
6865
6866 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6867 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6868 }
6869 else
6870 {
6871 wxGridEvent gridEvt( GetId(), type, this, row, col );
6872
6873 claimed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(gridEvt);
6874 vetoed = !gridEvt.IsAllowed();
6875 }
6876
6877 // A Veto'd event may not be `claimed' so test this first
6878 if (vetoed)
6879 return -1;
6880
6881 return claimed ? 1 : 0;
6882 }
6883
6884 void wxGrid::OnPaint( wxPaintEvent& WXUNUSED(event) )
6885 {
6886 // needed to prevent zillions of paint events on MSW
6887 wxPaintDC dc(this);
6888 }
6889
6890 void wxGrid::Refresh(bool eraseb, const wxRect* rect)
6891 {
6892 // Don't do anything if between Begin/EndBatch...
6893 // EndBatch() will do all this on the last nested one anyway.
6894 if ( m_created && !GetBatchCount() )
6895 {
6896 // Refresh to get correct scrolled position:
6897 wxScrolledWindow::Refresh(eraseb, rect);
6898
6899 if (rect)
6900 {
6901 int rect_x, rect_y, rectWidth, rectHeight;
6902 int width_label, width_cell, height_label, height_cell;
6903 int x, y;
6904
6905 // Copy rectangle can get scroll offsets..
6906 rect_x = rect->GetX();
6907 rect_y = rect->GetY();
6908 rectWidth = rect->GetWidth();
6909 rectHeight = rect->GetHeight();
6910
6911 width_label = m_rowLabelWidth - rect_x;
6912 if (width_label > rectWidth)
6913 width_label = rectWidth;
6914
6915 height_label = m_colLabelHeight - rect_y;
6916 if (height_label > rectHeight)
6917 height_label = rectHeight;
6918
6919 if (rect_x > m_rowLabelWidth)
6920 {
6921 x = rect_x - m_rowLabelWidth;
6922 width_cell = rectWidth;
6923 }
6924 else
6925 {
6926 x = 0;
6927 width_cell = rectWidth - (m_rowLabelWidth - rect_x);
6928 }
6929
6930 if (rect_y > m_colLabelHeight)
6931 {
6932 y = rect_y - m_colLabelHeight;
6933 height_cell = rectHeight;
6934 }
6935 else
6936 {
6937 y = 0;
6938 height_cell = rectHeight - (m_colLabelHeight - rect_y);
6939 }
6940
6941 // Paint corner label part intersecting rect.
6942 if ( width_label > 0 && height_label > 0 )
6943 {
6944 wxRect anotherrect(rect_x, rect_y, width_label, height_label);
6945 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
6946 }
6947
6948 // Paint col labels part intersecting rect.
6949 if ( width_cell > 0 && height_label > 0 )
6950 {
6951 wxRect anotherrect(x, rect_y, width_cell, height_label);
6952 m_colLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
6953 }
6954
6955 // Paint row labels part intersecting rect.
6956 if ( width_label > 0 && height_cell > 0 )
6957 {
6958 wxRect anotherrect(rect_x, y, width_label, height_cell);
6959 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
6960 }
6961
6962 // Paint cell area part intersecting rect.
6963 if ( width_cell > 0 && height_cell > 0 )
6964 {
6965 wxRect anotherrect(x, y, width_cell, height_cell);
6966 m_gridWin->Refresh(eraseb, &anotherrect);
6967 }
6968 }
6969 else
6970 {
6971 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
6972 m_colLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
6973 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
6974 m_gridWin->Refresh(eraseb, NULL);
6975 }
6976 }
6977 }
6978
6979 void wxGrid::OnSize(wxSizeEvent& WXUNUSED(event))
6980 {
6981 if (m_targetWindow != this) // check whether initialisation has been done
6982 {
6983 // update our children window positions and scrollbars
6984 CalcDimensions();
6985 }
6986 }
6987
6988 void wxGrid::OnKeyDown( wxKeyEvent& event )
6989 {
6990 if ( m_inOnKeyDown )
6991 {
6992 // shouldn't be here - we are going round in circles...
6993 //
6994 wxFAIL_MSG( wxT("wxGrid::OnKeyDown called while already active") );
6995 }
6996
6997 m_inOnKeyDown = true;
6998
6999 // propagate the event up and see if it gets processed
7000 wxWindow *parent = GetParent();
7001 wxKeyEvent keyEvt( event );
7002 keyEvt.SetEventObject( parent );
7003
7004 if ( !parent->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent( keyEvt ) )
7005 {
7006 if (GetLayoutDirection() == wxLayout_RightToLeft)
7007 {
7008 if (event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_RIGHT)
7009 event.m_keyCode = WXK_LEFT;
7010 else if (event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_LEFT)
7011 event.m_keyCode = WXK_RIGHT;
7012 }
7013
7014 // try local handlers
7015 switch ( event.GetKeyCode() )
7016 {
7017 case WXK_UP:
7018 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7019 MoveCursorUpBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7020 else
7021 MoveCursorUp( event.ShiftDown() );
7022 break;
7023
7024 case WXK_DOWN:
7025 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7026 MoveCursorDownBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7027 else
7028 MoveCursorDown( event.ShiftDown() );
7029 break;
7030
7031 case WXK_LEFT:
7032 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7033 MoveCursorLeftBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7034 else
7035 MoveCursorLeft( event.ShiftDown() );
7036 break;
7037
7038 case WXK_RIGHT:
7039 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7040 MoveCursorRightBlock( event.ShiftDown() );
7041 else
7042 MoveCursorRight( event.ShiftDown() );
7043 break;
7044
7045 case WXK_RETURN:
7046 case WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER:
7047 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7048 {
7049 event.Skip(); // to let the edit control have the return
7050 }
7051 else
7052 {
7053 if ( GetGridCursorRow() < GetNumberRows()-1 )
7054 {
7055 MoveCursorDown( event.ShiftDown() );
7056 }
7057 else
7058 {
7059 // at the bottom of a column
7060 DisableCellEditControl();
7061 }
7062 }
7063 break;
7064
7065 case WXK_ESCAPE:
7066 ClearSelection();
7067 break;
7068
7069 case WXK_TAB:
7070 if (event.ShiftDown())
7071 {
7072 if ( GetGridCursorCol() > 0 )
7073 {
7074 MoveCursorLeft( false );
7075 }
7076 else
7077 {
7078 // at left of grid
7079 DisableCellEditControl();
7080 }
7081 }
7082 else
7083 {
7084 if ( GetGridCursorCol() < GetNumberCols() - 1 )
7085 {
7086 MoveCursorRight( false );
7087 }
7088 else
7089 {
7090 // at right of grid
7091 DisableCellEditControl();
7092 }
7093 }
7094 break;
7095
7096 case WXK_HOME:
7097 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7098 {
7099 MakeCellVisible( 0, 0 );
7100 SetCurrentCell( 0, 0 );
7101 }
7102 else
7103 {
7104 event.Skip();
7105 }
7106 break;
7107
7108 case WXK_END:
7109 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7110 {
7111 MakeCellVisible( m_numRows - 1, m_numCols - 1 );
7112 SetCurrentCell( m_numRows - 1, m_numCols - 1 );
7113 }
7114 else
7115 {
7116 event.Skip();
7117 }
7118 break;
7119
7120 case WXK_PAGEUP:
7121 MovePageUp();
7122 break;
7123
7124 case WXK_PAGEDOWN:
7125 MovePageDown();
7126 break;
7127
7128 case WXK_SPACE:
7129 if ( event.ControlDown() )
7130 {
7131 if ( m_selection )
7132 {
7133 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(
7134 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow(),
7135 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol(),
7136 event.ControlDown(),
7137 event.ShiftDown(),
7138 event.AltDown(),
7139 event.MetaDown() );
7140 }
7141 break;
7142 }
7143
7144 if ( !IsEditable() )
7145 MoveCursorRight( false );
7146 else
7147 event.Skip();
7148 break;
7149
7150 default:
7151 event.Skip();
7152 break;
7153 }
7154 }
7155
7156 m_inOnKeyDown = false;
7157 }
7158
7159 void wxGrid::OnKeyUp( wxKeyEvent& event )
7160 {
7161 // try local handlers
7162 //
7163 if ( event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_SHIFT )
7164 {
7165 if ( m_selectingTopLeft != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
7166 m_selectingBottomRight != wxGridNoCellCoords )
7167 {
7168 if ( m_selection )
7169 {
7170 m_selection->SelectBlock(
7171 m_selectingTopLeft.GetRow(),
7172 m_selectingTopLeft.GetCol(),
7173 m_selectingBottomRight.GetRow(),
7174 m_selectingBottomRight.GetCol(),
7175 event.ControlDown(),
7176 true,
7177 event.AltDown(),
7178 event.MetaDown() );
7179 }
7180 }
7181
7182 m_selectingTopLeft = wxGridNoCellCoords;
7183 m_selectingBottomRight = wxGridNoCellCoords;
7184 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridNoCellCoords;
7185 }
7186 }
7187
7188 void wxGrid::OnChar( wxKeyEvent& event )
7189 {
7190 // is it possible to edit the current cell at all?
7191 if ( !IsCellEditControlEnabled() && CanEnableCellControl() )
7192 {
7193 // yes, now check whether the cells editor accepts the key
7194 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
7195 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
7196 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
7197 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
7198
7199 // <F2> is special and will always start editing, for
7200 // other keys - ask the editor itself
7201 if ( (event.GetKeyCode() == WXK_F2 && !event.HasModifiers())
7202 || editor->IsAcceptedKey(event) )
7203 {
7204 // ensure cell is visble
7205 MakeCellVisible(row, col);
7206 EnableCellEditControl();
7207
7208 // a problem can arise if the cell is not completely
7209 // visible (even after calling MakeCellVisible the
7210 // control is not created and calling StartingKey will
7211 // crash the app
7212 if ( event.GetKeyCode() != WXK_F2 && editor->IsCreated() && m_cellEditCtrlEnabled )
7213 editor->StartingKey(event);
7214 }
7215 else
7216 {
7217 event.Skip();
7218 }
7219
7220 editor->DecRef();
7221 attr->DecRef();
7222 }
7223 else
7224 {
7225 event.Skip();
7226 }
7227 }
7228
7229 void wxGrid::OnEraseBackground(wxEraseEvent&)
7230 {
7231 }
7232
7233 void wxGrid::SetCurrentCell( const wxGridCellCoords& coords )
7234 {
7235 if ( SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_SELECT_CELL, coords.GetRow(), coords.GetCol() ) )
7236 {
7237 // the event has been intercepted - do nothing
7238 return;
7239 }
7240
7241 #if !defined(__WXMAC__)
7242 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
7243 PrepareDC( dc );
7244 #endif
7245
7246 if ( m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords )
7247 {
7248 DisableCellEditControl();
7249
7250 if ( IsVisible( m_currentCellCoords, false ) )
7251 {
7252 wxRect r;
7253 r = BlockToDeviceRect( m_currentCellCoords, m_currentCellCoords );
7254 if ( !m_gridLinesEnabled )
7255 {
7256 r.x--;
7257 r.y--;
7258 r.width++;
7259 r.height++;
7260 }
7261
7262 wxGridCellCoordsArray cells = CalcCellsExposed( r );
7263
7264 // Otherwise refresh redraws the highlight!
7265 m_currentCellCoords = coords;
7266
7267 #if defined(__WXMAC__)
7268 m_gridWin->Refresh(true /*, & r */);
7269 #else
7270 DrawGridCellArea( dc, cells );
7271 DrawAllGridLines( dc, r );
7272 #endif
7273 }
7274 }
7275
7276 m_currentCellCoords = coords;
7277
7278 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr( coords );
7279 #if !defined(__WXMAC__)
7280 DrawCellHighlight( dc, attr );
7281 #endif
7282 attr->DecRef();
7283 }
7284
7285 void wxGrid::HighlightBlock( int topRow, int leftCol, int bottomRow, int rightCol )
7286 {
7287 int temp;
7288 wxGridCellCoords updateTopLeft, updateBottomRight;
7289
7290 if ( m_selection )
7291 {
7292 if ( m_selection->GetSelectionMode() == wxGrid::wxGridSelectRows )
7293 {
7294 leftCol = 0;
7295 rightCol = GetNumberCols() - 1;
7296 }
7297 else if ( m_selection->GetSelectionMode() == wxGrid::wxGridSelectColumns )
7298 {
7299 topRow = 0;
7300 bottomRow = GetNumberRows() - 1;
7301 }
7302 }
7303
7304 if ( topRow > bottomRow )
7305 {
7306 temp = topRow;
7307 topRow = bottomRow;
7308 bottomRow = temp;
7309 }
7310
7311 if ( leftCol > rightCol )
7312 {
7313 temp = leftCol;
7314 leftCol = rightCol;
7315 rightCol = temp;
7316 }
7317
7318 updateTopLeft = wxGridCellCoords( topRow, leftCol );
7319 updateBottomRight = wxGridCellCoords( bottomRow, rightCol );
7320
7321 // First the case that we selected a completely new area
7322 if ( m_selectingTopLeft == wxGridNoCellCoords ||
7323 m_selectingBottomRight == wxGridNoCellCoords )
7324 {
7325 wxRect rect;
7326 rect = BlockToDeviceRect( wxGridCellCoords ( topRow, leftCol ),
7327 wxGridCellCoords ( bottomRow, rightCol ) );
7328 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
7329 }
7330
7331 // Now handle changing an existing selection area.
7332 else if ( m_selectingTopLeft != updateTopLeft ||
7333 m_selectingBottomRight != updateBottomRight )
7334 {
7335 // Compute two optimal update rectangles:
7336 // Either one rectangle is a real subset of the
7337 // other, or they are (almost) disjoint!
7338 wxRect rect[4];
7339 bool need_refresh[4];
7340 need_refresh[0] =
7341 need_refresh[1] =
7342 need_refresh[2] =
7343 need_refresh[3] = false;
7344 int i;
7345
7346 // Store intermediate values
7347 wxCoord oldLeft = m_selectingTopLeft.GetCol();
7348 wxCoord oldTop = m_selectingTopLeft.GetRow();
7349 wxCoord oldRight = m_selectingBottomRight.GetCol();
7350 wxCoord oldBottom = m_selectingBottomRight.GetRow();
7351
7352 // Determine the outer/inner coordinates.
7353 if (oldLeft > leftCol)
7354 {
7355 temp = oldLeft;
7356 oldLeft = leftCol;
7357 leftCol = temp;
7358 }
7359 if (oldTop > topRow )
7360 {
7361 temp = oldTop;
7362 oldTop = topRow;
7363 topRow = temp;
7364 }
7365 if (oldRight < rightCol )
7366 {
7367 temp = oldRight;
7368 oldRight = rightCol;
7369 rightCol = temp;
7370 }
7371 if (oldBottom < bottomRow)
7372 {
7373 temp = oldBottom;
7374 oldBottom = bottomRow;
7375 bottomRow = temp;
7376 }
7377
7378 // Now, either the stuff marked old is the outer
7379 // rectangle or we don't have a situation where one
7380 // is contained in the other.
7381
7382 if ( oldLeft < leftCol )
7383 {
7384 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7385 // area to the left of the old or new selection.
7386 need_refresh[0] = true;
7387 rect[0] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7388 wxGridCellCoords( oldTop, oldLeft ),
7389 wxGridCellCoords( oldBottom, leftCol - 1 ) );
7390 }
7391
7392 if ( oldTop < topRow )
7393 {
7394 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7395 // area above the old or new selection.
7396 need_refresh[1] = true;
7397 rect[1] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7398 wxGridCellCoords( oldTop, leftCol ),
7399 wxGridCellCoords( topRow - 1, rightCol ) );
7400 }
7401
7402 if ( oldRight > rightCol )
7403 {
7404 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7405 // area to the right of the old or new selection.
7406 need_refresh[2] = true;
7407 rect[2] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7408 wxGridCellCoords( oldTop, rightCol + 1 ),
7409 wxGridCellCoords( oldBottom, oldRight ) );
7410 }
7411
7412 if ( oldBottom > bottomRow )
7413 {
7414 // Refresh the newly selected or deselected
7415 // area below the old or new selection.
7416 need_refresh[3] = true;
7417 rect[3] = BlockToDeviceRect(
7418 wxGridCellCoords( bottomRow + 1, leftCol ),
7419 wxGridCellCoords( oldBottom, rightCol ) );
7420 }
7421
7422 // various Refresh() calls
7423 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++ )
7424 if ( need_refresh[i] && rect[i] != wxGridNoCellRect )
7425 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &(rect[i]) );
7426 }
7427
7428 // change selection
7429 m_selectingTopLeft = updateTopLeft;
7430 m_selectingBottomRight = updateBottomRight;
7431 }
7432
7433 //
7434 // ------ functions to get/send data (see also public functions)
7435 //
7436
7437 bool wxGrid::GetModelValues()
7438 {
7439 // Hide the editor, so it won't hide a changed value.
7440 HideCellEditControl();
7441
7442 if ( m_table )
7443 {
7444 // all we need to do is repaint the grid
7445 //
7446 m_gridWin->Refresh();
7447 return true;
7448 }
7449
7450 return false;
7451 }
7452
7453 bool wxGrid::SetModelValues()
7454 {
7455 int row, col;
7456
7457 // Disable the editor, so it won't hide a changed value.
7458 // Do we also want to save the current value of the editor first?
7459 // I think so ...
7460 DisableCellEditControl();
7461
7462 if ( m_table )
7463 {
7464 for ( row = 0; row < m_numRows; row++ )
7465 {
7466 for ( col = 0; col < m_numCols; col++ )
7467 {
7468 m_table->SetValue( row, col, GetCellValue(row, col) );
7469 }
7470 }
7471
7472 return true;
7473 }
7474
7475 return false;
7476 }
7477
7478 // Note - this function only draws cells that are in the list of
7479 // exposed cells (usually set from the update region by
7480 // CalcExposedCells)
7481 //
7482 void wxGrid::DrawGridCellArea( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoordsArray& cells )
7483 {
7484 if ( !m_numRows || !m_numCols )
7485 return;
7486
7487 int i, numCells = cells.GetCount();
7488 int row, col, cell_rows, cell_cols;
7489 wxGridCellCoordsArray redrawCells;
7490
7491 for ( i = numCells - 1; i >= 0; i-- )
7492 {
7493 row = cells[i].GetRow();
7494 col = cells[i].GetCol();
7495 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
7496
7497 // If this cell is part of a multicell block, find owner for repaint
7498 if ( cell_rows <= 0 || cell_cols <= 0 )
7499 {
7500 wxGridCellCoords cell( row + cell_rows, col + cell_cols );
7501 bool marked = false;
7502 for ( int j = 0; j < numCells; j++ )
7503 {
7504 if ( cell == cells[j] )
7505 {
7506 marked = true;
7507 break;
7508 }
7509 }
7510
7511 if (!marked)
7512 {
7513 int count = redrawCells.GetCount();
7514 for (int j = 0; j < count; j++)
7515 {
7516 if ( cell == redrawCells[j] )
7517 {
7518 marked = true;
7519 break;
7520 }
7521 }
7522
7523 if (!marked)
7524 redrawCells.Add( cell );
7525 }
7526
7527 // don't bother drawing this cell
7528 continue;
7529 }
7530
7531 // If this cell is empty, find cell to left that might want to overflow
7532 if (m_table && m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col))
7533 {
7534 for ( int l = 0; l < cell_rows; l++ )
7535 {
7536 // find a cell in this row to leave already marked for repaint
7537 int left = col;
7538 for (int k = 0; k < int(redrawCells.GetCount()); k++)
7539 if ((redrawCells[k].GetCol() < left) &&
7540 (redrawCells[k].GetRow() == row))
7541 {
7542 left = redrawCells[k].GetCol();
7543 }
7544
7545 if (left == col)
7546 left = 0; // oh well
7547
7548 for (int j = col - 1; j >= left; j--)
7549 {
7550 if (!m_table->IsEmptyCell(row + l, j))
7551 {
7552 if (GetCellOverflow(row + l, j))
7553 {
7554 wxGridCellCoords cell(row + l, j);
7555 bool marked = false;
7556
7557 for (int k = 0; k < numCells; k++)
7558 {
7559 if ( cell == cells[k] )
7560 {
7561 marked = true;
7562 break;
7563 }
7564 }
7565
7566 if (!marked)
7567 {
7568 int count = redrawCells.GetCount();
7569 for (int k = 0; k < count; k++)
7570 {
7571 if ( cell == redrawCells[k] )
7572 {
7573 marked = true;
7574 break;
7575 }
7576 }
7577 if (!marked)
7578 redrawCells.Add( cell );
7579 }
7580 }
7581 break;
7582 }
7583 }
7584 }
7585 }
7586
7587 DrawCell( dc, cells[i] );
7588 }
7589
7590 numCells = redrawCells.GetCount();
7591
7592 for ( i = numCells - 1; i >= 0; i-- )
7593 {
7594 DrawCell( dc, redrawCells[i] );
7595 }
7596 }
7597
7598 void wxGrid::DrawGridSpace( wxDC& dc )
7599 {
7600 int cw, ch;
7601 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
7602
7603 int right, bottom;
7604 CalcUnscrolledPosition( cw, ch, &right, &bottom );
7605
7606 int rightCol = m_numCols > 0 ? GetColRight(GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 )) : 0;
7607 int bottomRow = m_numRows > 0 ? GetRowBottom(m_numRows - 1) : 0;
7608
7609 if ( right > rightCol || bottom > bottomRow )
7610 {
7611 int left, top;
7612 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &top );
7613
7614 dc.SetBrush( wxBrush(GetDefaultCellBackgroundColour(), wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID) );
7615 dc.SetPen( *wxTRANSPARENT_PEN );
7616
7617 if ( right > rightCol )
7618 {
7619 dc.DrawRectangle( rightCol, top, right - rightCol, ch );
7620 }
7621
7622 if ( bottom > bottomRow )
7623 {
7624 dc.DrawRectangle( left, bottomRow, cw, bottom - bottomRow );
7625 }
7626 }
7627 }
7628
7629 void wxGrid::DrawCell( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoords& coords )
7630 {
7631 int row = coords.GetRow();
7632 int col = coords.GetCol();
7633
7634 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
7635 return;
7636
7637 // we draw the cell border ourselves
7638 #if !WXGRID_DRAW_LINES
7639 if ( m_gridLinesEnabled )
7640 DrawCellBorder( dc, coords );
7641 #endif
7642
7643 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
7644
7645 bool isCurrent = coords == m_currentCellCoords;
7646
7647 wxRect rect = CellToRect( row, col );
7648
7649 // if the editor is shown, we should use it and not the renderer
7650 // Note: However, only if it is really _shown_, i.e. not hidden!
7651 if ( isCurrent && IsCellEditControlShown() )
7652 {
7653 // NB: this "#if..." is temporary and fixes a problem where the
7654 // edit control is erased by this code after being rendered.
7655 // On wxMac (QD build only), the cell editor is a wxTextCntl and is rendered
7656 // implicitly, causing this out-of order render.
7657 #if !defined(__WXMAC__)
7658 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
7659 editor->PaintBackground(rect, attr);
7660 editor->DecRef();
7661 #endif
7662 }
7663 else
7664 {
7665 // but all the rest is drawn by the cell renderer and hence may be customized
7666 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = attr->GetRenderer(this, row, col);
7667 renderer->Draw(*this, *attr, dc, rect, row, col, IsInSelection(coords));
7668 renderer->DecRef();
7669 }
7670
7671 attr->DecRef();
7672 }
7673
7674 void wxGrid::DrawCellHighlight( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellAttr *attr )
7675 {
7676 // don't show highlight when the grid doesn't have focus
7677 if ( !HasFocus() )
7678 return;
7679
7680 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
7681 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
7682
7683 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
7684 return;
7685
7686 wxRect rect = CellToRect(row, col);
7687
7688 // hmmm... what could we do here to show that the cell is disabled?
7689 // for now, I just draw a thinner border than for the other ones, but
7690 // it doesn't look really good
7691
7692 int penWidth = attr->IsReadOnly() ? m_cellHighlightROPenWidth : m_cellHighlightPenWidth;
7693
7694 if (penWidth > 0)
7695 {
7696 // The center of the drawn line is where the position/width/height of
7697 // the rectangle is actually at (on wxMSW at least), so the
7698 // size of the rectangle is reduced to compensate for the thickness of
7699 // the line. If this is too strange on non-wxMSW platforms then
7700 // please #ifdef this appropriately.
7701 rect.x += penWidth / 2;
7702 rect.y += penWidth / 2;
7703 rect.width -= penWidth - 1;
7704 rect.height -= penWidth - 1;
7705
7706 // Now draw the rectangle
7707 // use the cellHighlightColour if the cell is inside a selection, this
7708 // will ensure the cell is always visible.
7709 dc.SetPen(wxPen(IsInSelection(row,col) ? m_selectionForeground : m_cellHighlightColour, penWidth, wxPENSTYLE_SOLID));
7710 dc.SetBrush(*wxTRANSPARENT_BRUSH);
7711 dc.DrawRectangle(rect);
7712 }
7713
7714 #if 0
7715 // VZ: my experiments with 3D borders...
7716
7717 // how to properly set colours for arbitrary bg?
7718 wxCoord x1 = rect.x,
7719 y1 = rect.y,
7720 x2 = rect.x + rect.width - 1,
7721 y2 = rect.y + rect.height - 1;
7722
7723 dc.SetPen(*wxWHITE_PEN);
7724 dc.DrawLine(x1, y1, x2, y1);
7725 dc.DrawLine(x1, y1, x1, y2);
7726
7727 dc.DrawLine(x1 + 1, y2 - 1, x2 - 1, y2 - 1);
7728 dc.DrawLine(x2 - 1, y1 + 1, x2 - 1, y2);
7729
7730 dc.SetPen(*wxBLACK_PEN);
7731 dc.DrawLine(x1, y2, x2, y2);
7732 dc.DrawLine(x2, y1, x2, y2 + 1);
7733 #endif
7734 }
7735
7736 wxPen wxGrid::GetDefaultGridLinePen()
7737 {
7738 return wxPen(GetGridLineColour(), 1, wxPENSTYLE_SOLID);
7739 }
7740
7741 wxPen wxGrid::GetRowGridLinePen(int WXUNUSED(row))
7742 {
7743 return GetDefaultGridLinePen();
7744 }
7745
7746 wxPen wxGrid::GetColGridLinePen(int WXUNUSED(col))
7747 {
7748 return GetDefaultGridLinePen();
7749 }
7750
7751 void wxGrid::DrawCellBorder( wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoords& coords )
7752 {
7753 int row = coords.GetRow();
7754 int col = coords.GetCol();
7755 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
7756 return;
7757
7758
7759 wxRect rect = CellToRect( row, col );
7760
7761 // right hand border
7762 dc.SetPen( GetColGridLinePen(col) );
7763 dc.DrawLine( rect.x + rect.width, rect.y,
7764 rect.x + rect.width, rect.y + rect.height + 1 );
7765
7766 // bottom border
7767 dc.SetPen( GetRowGridLinePen(row) );
7768 dc.DrawLine( rect.x, rect.y + rect.height,
7769 rect.x + rect.width, rect.y + rect.height);
7770 }
7771
7772 void wxGrid::DrawHighlight(wxDC& dc, const wxGridCellCoordsArray& cells)
7773 {
7774 // This if block was previously in wxGrid::OnPaint but that doesn't
7775 // seem to get called under wxGTK - MB
7776 //
7777 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords &&
7778 m_numRows && m_numCols )
7779 {
7780 m_currentCellCoords.Set(0, 0);
7781 }
7782
7783 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
7784 {
7785 // don't show highlight when the edit control is shown
7786 return;
7787 }
7788
7789 // if the active cell was repainted, repaint its highlight too because it
7790 // might have been damaged by the grid lines
7791 size_t count = cells.GetCount();
7792 for ( size_t n = 0; n < count; n++ )
7793 {
7794 if ( cells[n] == m_currentCellCoords )
7795 {
7796 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(m_currentCellCoords);
7797 DrawCellHighlight(dc, attr);
7798 attr->DecRef();
7799
7800 break;
7801 }
7802 }
7803 }
7804
7805 // TODO: remove this ???
7806 // This is used to redraw all grid lines e.g. when the grid line colour
7807 // has been changed
7808 //
7809 void wxGrid::DrawAllGridLines( wxDC& dc, const wxRegion & WXUNUSED(reg) )
7810 {
7811 #if !WXGRID_DRAW_LINES
7812 return;
7813 #endif
7814
7815 if ( !m_gridLinesEnabled || !m_numRows || !m_numCols )
7816 return;
7817
7818 int top, bottom, left, right;
7819
7820 #if 0 //#ifndef __WXGTK__
7821 if (reg.IsEmpty())
7822 {
7823 int cw, ch;
7824 m_gridWin->GetClientSize(&cw, &ch);
7825
7826 // virtual coords of visible area
7827 //
7828 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &top );
7829 CalcUnscrolledPosition( cw, ch, &right, &bottom );
7830 }
7831 else
7832 {
7833 wxCoord x, y, w, h;
7834 reg.GetBox(x, y, w, h);
7835 CalcUnscrolledPosition( x, y, &left, &top );
7836 CalcUnscrolledPosition( x + w, y + h, &right, &bottom );
7837 }
7838 #else
7839 int cw, ch;
7840 m_gridWin->GetClientSize(&cw, &ch);
7841 CalcUnscrolledPosition( 0, 0, &left, &top );
7842 CalcUnscrolledPosition( cw, ch, &right, &bottom );
7843 #endif
7844
7845 // avoid drawing grid lines past the last row and col
7846 //
7847 right = wxMin( right, GetColRight(GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 )) );
7848 bottom = wxMin( bottom, GetRowBottom(m_numRows - 1) );
7849
7850 // no gridlines inside multicells, clip them out
7851 int leftCol = GetColPos( internalXToCol(left) );
7852 int topRow = internalYToRow(top);
7853 int rightCol = GetColPos( internalXToCol(right) );
7854 int bottomRow = internalYToRow(bottom);
7855
7856 wxRegion clippedcells(0, 0, cw, ch);
7857
7858 int i, j, cell_rows, cell_cols;
7859 wxRect rect;
7860
7861 for (j=topRow; j<=bottomRow; j++)
7862 {
7863 int colPos;
7864 for (colPos=leftCol; colPos<=rightCol; colPos++)
7865 {
7866 i = GetColAt( colPos );
7867
7868 GetCellSize( j, i, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
7869 if ((cell_rows > 1) || (cell_cols > 1))
7870 {
7871 rect = CellToRect(j,i);
7872 CalcScrolledPosition( rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
7873 clippedcells.Subtract(rect);
7874 }
7875 else if ((cell_rows < 0) || (cell_cols < 0))
7876 {
7877 rect = CellToRect(j + cell_rows, i + cell_cols);
7878 CalcScrolledPosition( rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
7879 clippedcells.Subtract(rect);
7880 }
7881 }
7882 }
7883
7884 dc.SetDeviceClippingRegion( clippedcells );
7885
7886
7887 // horizontal grid lines
7888 //
7889 // already declared above - int i;
7890 for ( i = internalYToRow(top); i < m_numRows; i++ )
7891 {
7892 int bot = GetRowBottom(i) - 1;
7893
7894 if ( bot > bottom )
7895 {
7896 break;
7897 }
7898
7899 if ( bot >= top )
7900 {
7901 dc.SetPen( GetRowGridLinePen(i) );
7902 dc.DrawLine( left, bot, right, bot );
7903 }
7904 }
7905
7906 // vertical grid lines
7907 //
7908 int colPos;
7909 for ( colPos = leftCol; colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
7910 {
7911 i = GetColAt( colPos );
7912
7913 int colRight = GetColRight(i);
7914 #ifdef __WXGTK__
7915 if (GetLayoutDirection() != wxLayout_RightToLeft)
7916 #endif
7917 colRight--;
7918
7919 if ( colRight > right )
7920 {
7921 break;
7922 }
7923
7924 if ( colRight >= left )
7925 {
7926 dc.SetPen( GetColGridLinePen(i) );
7927 dc.DrawLine( colRight, top, colRight, bottom );
7928 }
7929 }
7930
7931 dc.DestroyClippingRegion();
7932 }
7933
7934 void wxGrid::DrawRowLabels( wxDC& dc, const wxArrayInt& rows)
7935 {
7936 if ( !m_numRows )
7937 return;
7938
7939 size_t i;
7940 size_t numLabels = rows.GetCount();
7941
7942 for ( i = 0; i < numLabels; i++ )
7943 {
7944 DrawRowLabel( dc, rows[i] );
7945 }
7946 }
7947
7948 void wxGrid::DrawRowLabel( wxDC& dc, int row )
7949 {
7950 if ( GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 || m_rowLabelWidth <= 0 )
7951 return;
7952
7953 wxRect rect;
7954
7955 int rowTop = GetRowTop(row),
7956 rowBottom = GetRowBottom(row) - 1;
7957
7958 dc.SetPen( wxPen(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_3DSHADOW), 1, wxPENSTYLE_SOLID) );
7959 dc.DrawLine( m_rowLabelWidth - 1, rowTop, m_rowLabelWidth - 1, rowBottom );
7960 dc.DrawLine( 0, rowTop, 0, rowBottom );
7961 dc.DrawLine( 0, rowBottom, m_rowLabelWidth, rowBottom );
7962
7963 dc.SetPen( *wxWHITE_PEN );
7964 dc.DrawLine( 1, rowTop, 1, rowBottom );
7965 dc.DrawLine( 1, rowTop, m_rowLabelWidth - 1, rowTop );
7966
7967 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT );
7968 dc.SetTextForeground( GetLabelTextColour() );
7969 dc.SetFont( GetLabelFont() );
7970
7971 int hAlign, vAlign;
7972 GetRowLabelAlignment( &hAlign, &vAlign );
7973
7974 rect.SetX( 2 );
7975 rect.SetY( GetRowTop(row) + 2 );
7976 rect.SetWidth( m_rowLabelWidth - 4 );
7977 rect.SetHeight( GetRowHeight(row) - 4 );
7978 DrawTextRectangle( dc, GetRowLabelValue( row ), rect, hAlign, vAlign );
7979 }
7980
7981 void wxGrid::SetUseNativeColLabels( bool native )
7982 {
7983 m_nativeColumnLabels = native;
7984 if (native)
7985 {
7986 int height = wxRendererNative::Get().GetHeaderButtonHeight( this );
7987 SetColLabelSize( height );
7988 }
7989
7990 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
7991 }
7992
7993 void wxGrid::DrawColLabels( wxDC& dc,const wxArrayInt& cols )
7994 {
7995 if ( !m_numCols )
7996 return;
7997
7998 size_t i;
7999 size_t numLabels = cols.GetCount();
8000
8001 for ( i = 0; i < numLabels; i++ )
8002 {
8003 DrawColLabel( dc, cols[i] );
8004 }
8005 }
8006
8007 void wxGrid::DrawColLabel( wxDC& dc, int col )
8008 {
8009 if ( GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || m_colLabelHeight <= 0 )
8010 return;
8011
8012 int colLeft = GetColLeft(col);
8013
8014 wxRect rect;
8015
8016 if (m_nativeColumnLabels)
8017 {
8018 rect.SetX( colLeft);
8019 rect.SetY( 0 );
8020 rect.SetWidth( GetColWidth(col));
8021 rect.SetHeight( m_colLabelHeight );
8022
8023 wxWindowDC *win_dc = (wxWindowDC*) &dc;
8024 wxRendererNative::Get().DrawHeaderButton( win_dc->GetWindow(), dc, rect, 0 );
8025 }
8026 else
8027 {
8028 int colRight = GetColRight(col) - 1;
8029
8030 dc.SetPen( wxPen(wxSystemSettings::GetColour(wxSYS_COLOUR_3DSHADOW), 1, wxPENSTYLE_SOLID) );
8031 dc.DrawLine( colRight, 0, colRight, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8032 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 0, colRight, 0 );
8033 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, m_colLabelHeight - 1,
8034 colRight + 1, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8035
8036 dc.SetPen( *wxWHITE_PEN );
8037 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colLeft, m_colLabelHeight - 1 );
8038 dc.DrawLine( colLeft, 1, colRight, 1 );
8039 }
8040
8041 dc.SetBackgroundMode( wxBRUSHSTYLE_TRANSPARENT );
8042 dc.SetTextForeground( GetLabelTextColour() );
8043 dc.SetFont( GetLabelFont() );
8044
8045 int hAlign, vAlign, orient;
8046 GetColLabelAlignment( &hAlign, &vAlign );
8047 orient = GetColLabelTextOrientation();
8048
8049 rect.SetX( colLeft + 2 );
8050 rect.SetY( 2 );
8051 rect.SetWidth( GetColWidth(col) - 4 );
8052 rect.SetHeight( m_colLabelHeight - 4 );
8053 DrawTextRectangle( dc, GetColLabelValue( col ), rect, hAlign, vAlign, orient );
8054 }
8055
8056 void wxGrid::DrawTextRectangle( wxDC& dc,
8057 const wxString& value,
8058 const wxRect& rect,
8059 int horizAlign,
8060 int vertAlign,
8061 int textOrientation )
8062 {
8063 wxArrayString lines;
8064
8065 StringToLines( value, lines );
8066
8067 // Forward to new API.
8068 DrawTextRectangle( dc,
8069 lines,
8070 rect,
8071 horizAlign,
8072 vertAlign,
8073 textOrientation );
8074 }
8075
8076 // VZ: this should be replaced with wxDC::DrawLabel() to which we just have to
8077 // add textOrientation support
8078 void wxGrid::DrawTextRectangle(wxDC& dc,
8079 const wxArrayString& lines,
8080 const wxRect& rect,
8081 int horizAlign,
8082 int vertAlign,
8083 int textOrientation)
8084 {
8085 if ( lines.empty() )
8086 return;
8087
8088 wxDCClipper clip(dc, rect);
8089
8090 long textWidth,
8091 textHeight;
8092
8093 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8094 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &textWidth, &textHeight );
8095 else
8096 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &textHeight, &textWidth );
8097
8098 int x = 0,
8099 y = 0;
8100 switch ( vertAlign )
8101 {
8102 case wxALIGN_BOTTOM:
8103 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8104 y = rect.y + (rect.height - textHeight - 1);
8105 else
8106 x = rect.x + rect.width - textWidth;
8107 break;
8108
8109 case wxALIGN_CENTRE:
8110 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8111 y = rect.y + ((rect.height - textHeight) / 2);
8112 else
8113 x = rect.x + ((rect.width - textWidth) / 2);
8114 break;
8115
8116 case wxALIGN_TOP:
8117 default:
8118 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8119 y = rect.y + 1;
8120 else
8121 x = rect.x + 1;
8122 break;
8123 }
8124
8125 // Align each line of a multi-line label
8126 size_t nLines = lines.GetCount();
8127 for ( size_t l = 0; l < nLines; l++ )
8128 {
8129 const wxString& line = lines[l];
8130
8131 if ( line.empty() )
8132 {
8133 *(textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL ? &y : &x) += dc.GetCharHeight();
8134 continue;
8135 }
8136
8137 wxCoord lineWidth = 0,
8138 lineHeight = 0;
8139 dc.GetTextExtent(line, &lineWidth, &lineHeight);
8140
8141 switch ( horizAlign )
8142 {
8143 case wxALIGN_RIGHT:
8144 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8145 x = rect.x + (rect.width - lineWidth - 1);
8146 else
8147 y = rect.y + lineWidth + 1;
8148 break;
8149
8150 case wxALIGN_CENTRE:
8151 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8152 x = rect.x + ((rect.width - lineWidth) / 2);
8153 else
8154 y = rect.y + rect.height - ((rect.height - lineWidth) / 2);
8155 break;
8156
8157 case wxALIGN_LEFT:
8158 default:
8159 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8160 x = rect.x + 1;
8161 else
8162 y = rect.y + rect.height - 1;
8163 break;
8164 }
8165
8166 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL )
8167 {
8168 dc.DrawText( line, x, y );
8169 y += lineHeight;
8170 }
8171 else
8172 {
8173 dc.DrawRotatedText( line, x, y, 90.0 );
8174 x += lineHeight;
8175 }
8176 }
8177 }
8178
8179 // Split multi-line text up into an array of strings.
8180 // Any existing contents of the string array are preserved.
8181 //
8182 // TODO: refactor wxTextFile::Read() and reuse the same code from here
8183 void wxGrid::StringToLines( const wxString& value, wxArrayString& lines ) const
8184 {
8185 int startPos = 0;
8186 int pos;
8187 wxString eol = wxTextFile::GetEOL( wxTextFileType_Unix );
8188 wxString tVal = wxTextFile::Translate( value, wxTextFileType_Unix );
8189
8190 while ( startPos < (int)tVal.length() )
8191 {
8192 pos = tVal.Mid(startPos).Find( eol );
8193 if ( pos < 0 )
8194 {
8195 break;
8196 }
8197 else if ( pos == 0 )
8198 {
8199 lines.Add( wxEmptyString );
8200 }
8201 else
8202 {
8203 lines.Add( tVal.Mid(startPos, pos) );
8204 }
8205
8206 startPos += pos + 1;
8207 }
8208
8209 if ( startPos < (int)tVal.length() )
8210 {
8211 lines.Add( tVal.Mid( startPos ) );
8212 }
8213 }
8214
8215 void wxGrid::GetTextBoxSize( const wxDC& dc,
8216 const wxArrayString& lines,
8217 long *width, long *height ) const
8218 {
8219 wxCoord w = 0;
8220 wxCoord h = 0;
8221 wxCoord lineW = 0, lineH = 0;
8222
8223 size_t i;
8224 for ( i = 0; i < lines.GetCount(); i++ )
8225 {
8226 dc.GetTextExtent( lines[i], &lineW, &lineH );
8227 w = wxMax( w, lineW );
8228 h += lineH;
8229 }
8230
8231 *width = w;
8232 *height = h;
8233 }
8234
8235 //
8236 // ------ Batch processing.
8237 //
8238 void wxGrid::EndBatch()
8239 {
8240 if ( m_batchCount > 0 )
8241 {
8242 m_batchCount--;
8243 if ( !m_batchCount )
8244 {
8245 CalcDimensions();
8246 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
8247 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
8248 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh();
8249 m_gridWin->Refresh();
8250 }
8251 }
8252 }
8253
8254 // Use this, rather than wxWindow::Refresh(), to force an immediate
8255 // repainting of the grid. Has no effect if you are already inside a
8256 // BeginBatch / EndBatch block.
8257 //
8258 void wxGrid::ForceRefresh()
8259 {
8260 BeginBatch();
8261 EndBatch();
8262 }
8263
8264 bool wxGrid::Enable(bool enable)
8265 {
8266 if ( !wxScrolledWindow::Enable(enable) )
8267 return false;
8268
8269 // redraw in the new state
8270 m_gridWin->Refresh();
8271
8272 return true;
8273 }
8274
8275 //
8276 // ------ Edit control functions
8277 //
8278
8279 void wxGrid::EnableEditing( bool edit )
8280 {
8281 // TODO: improve this ?
8282 //
8283 if ( edit != m_editable )
8284 {
8285 if (!edit)
8286 EnableCellEditControl(edit);
8287 m_editable = edit;
8288 }
8289 }
8290
8291 void wxGrid::EnableCellEditControl( bool enable )
8292 {
8293 if (! m_editable)
8294 return;
8295
8296 if ( enable != m_cellEditCtrlEnabled )
8297 {
8298 if ( enable )
8299 {
8300 if (SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_SHOWN) <0)
8301 return;
8302
8303 // this should be checked by the caller!
8304 wxASSERT_MSG( CanEnableCellControl(), _T("can't enable editing for this cell!") );
8305
8306 // do it before ShowCellEditControl()
8307 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = enable;
8308
8309 ShowCellEditControl();
8310 }
8311 else
8312 {
8313 //FIXME:add veto support
8314 SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_HIDDEN );
8315
8316 HideCellEditControl();
8317 SaveEditControlValue();
8318
8319 // do it after HideCellEditControl()
8320 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = enable;
8321 }
8322 }
8323 }
8324
8325 bool wxGrid::IsCurrentCellReadOnly() const
8326 {
8327 // const_cast
8328 wxGridCellAttr* attr = ((wxGrid *)this)->GetCellAttr(m_currentCellCoords);
8329 bool readonly = attr->IsReadOnly();
8330 attr->DecRef();
8331
8332 return readonly;
8333 }
8334
8335 bool wxGrid::CanEnableCellControl() const
8336 {
8337 return m_editable && (m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords) &&
8338 !IsCurrentCellReadOnly();
8339 }
8340
8341 bool wxGrid::IsCellEditControlEnabled() const
8342 {
8343 // the cell edit control might be disable for all cells or just for the
8344 // current one if it's read only
8345 return m_cellEditCtrlEnabled ? !IsCurrentCellReadOnly() : false;
8346 }
8347
8348 bool wxGrid::IsCellEditControlShown() const
8349 {
8350 bool isShown = false;
8351
8352 if ( m_cellEditCtrlEnabled )
8353 {
8354 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8355 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8356 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8357 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor((wxGrid*) this, row, col);
8358 attr->DecRef();
8359
8360 if ( editor )
8361 {
8362 if ( editor->IsCreated() )
8363 {
8364 isShown = editor->GetControl()->IsShown();
8365 }
8366
8367 editor->DecRef();
8368 }
8369 }
8370
8371 return isShown;
8372 }
8373
8374 void wxGrid::ShowCellEditControl()
8375 {
8376 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
8377 {
8378 if ( !IsVisible( m_currentCellCoords, false ) )
8379 {
8380 m_cellEditCtrlEnabled = false;
8381 return;
8382 }
8383 else
8384 {
8385 wxRect rect = CellToRect( m_currentCellCoords );
8386 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8387 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8388
8389 // if this is part of a multicell, find owner (topleft)
8390 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
8391 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8392 if ( cell_rows <= 0 || cell_cols <= 0 )
8393 {
8394 row += cell_rows;
8395 col += cell_cols;
8396 m_currentCellCoords.SetRow( row );
8397 m_currentCellCoords.SetCol( col );
8398 }
8399
8400 // erase the highlight and the cell contents because the editor
8401 // might not cover the entire cell
8402 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
8403 PrepareDC( dc );
8404 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8405 dc.SetBrush(wxBrush(attr->GetBackgroundColour(), wxBRUSHSTYLE_SOLID));
8406 dc.SetPen(*wxTRANSPARENT_PEN);
8407 dc.DrawRectangle(rect);
8408
8409 // convert to scrolled coords
8410 CalcScrolledPosition( rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
8411
8412 int nXMove = 0;
8413 if (rect.x < 0)
8414 nXMove = rect.x;
8415
8416 // cell is shifted by one pixel
8417 // However, don't allow x or y to become negative
8418 // since the SetSize() method interprets that as
8419 // "don't change."
8420 if (rect.x > 0)
8421 rect.x--;
8422 if (rect.y > 0)
8423 rect.y--;
8424
8425 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
8426 if ( !editor->IsCreated() )
8427 {
8428 editor->Create(m_gridWin, wxID_ANY,
8429 new wxGridCellEditorEvtHandler(this, editor));
8430
8431 wxGridEditorCreatedEvent evt(GetId(),
8432 wxEVT_GRID_EDITOR_CREATED,
8433 this,
8434 row,
8435 col,
8436 editor->GetControl());
8437 GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(evt);
8438 }
8439
8440 // resize editor to overflow into righthand cells if allowed
8441 int maxWidth = rect.width;
8442 wxString value = GetCellValue(row, col);
8443 if ( (value != wxEmptyString) && (attr->GetOverflow()) )
8444 {
8445 int y;
8446 GetTextExtent(value, &maxWidth, &y, NULL, NULL, &attr->GetFont());
8447 if (maxWidth < rect.width)
8448 maxWidth = rect.width;
8449 }
8450
8451 int client_right = m_gridWin->GetClientSize().GetWidth();
8452 if (rect.x + maxWidth > client_right)
8453 maxWidth = client_right - rect.x;
8454
8455 if ((maxWidth > rect.width) && (col < m_numCols) && m_table)
8456 {
8457 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8458 // may have changed earlier
8459 for (int i = col + cell_cols; i < m_numCols; i++)
8460 {
8461 int c_rows, c_cols;
8462 GetCellSize( row, i, &c_rows, &c_cols );
8463
8464 // looks weird going over a multicell
8465 if (m_table->IsEmptyCell( row, i ) &&
8466 (rect.width < maxWidth) && (c_rows == 1))
8467 {
8468 rect.width += GetColWidth( i );
8469 }
8470 else
8471 break;
8472 }
8473
8474 if (rect.GetRight() > client_right)
8475 rect.SetRight( client_right - 1 );
8476 }
8477
8478 editor->SetCellAttr( attr );
8479 editor->SetSize( rect );
8480 if (nXMove != 0)
8481 editor->GetControl()->Move(
8482 editor->GetControl()->GetPosition().x + nXMove,
8483 editor->GetControl()->GetPosition().y );
8484 editor->Show( true, attr );
8485
8486 // recalc dimensions in case we need to
8487 // expand the scrolled window to account for editor
8488 CalcDimensions();
8489
8490 editor->BeginEdit(row, col, this);
8491 editor->SetCellAttr(NULL);
8492
8493 editor->DecRef();
8494 attr->DecRef();
8495 }
8496 }
8497 }
8498
8499 void wxGrid::HideCellEditControl()
8500 {
8501 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
8502 {
8503 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8504 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8505
8506 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8507 wxGridCellEditor *editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
8508 editor->Show( false );
8509 editor->DecRef();
8510 attr->DecRef();
8511
8512 m_gridWin->SetFocus();
8513
8514 // refresh whole row to the right
8515 wxRect rect( CellToRect(row, col) );
8516 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y );
8517 rect.width = m_gridWin->GetClientSize().GetWidth() - rect.x;
8518
8519 #ifdef __WXMAC__
8520 // ensure that the pixels under the focus ring get refreshed as well
8521 rect.Inflate(10, 10);
8522 #endif
8523
8524 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
8525 }
8526 }
8527
8528 void wxGrid::SaveEditControlValue()
8529 {
8530 if ( IsCellEditControlEnabled() )
8531 {
8532 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
8533 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8534
8535 wxString oldval = GetCellValue(row, col);
8536
8537 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
8538 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
8539 bool changed = editor->EndEdit(row, col, this);
8540
8541 editor->DecRef();
8542 attr->DecRef();
8543
8544 if (changed)
8545 {
8546 if ( SendEvent( wxEVT_GRID_CELL_CHANGE,
8547 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow(),
8548 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() ) < 0 )
8549 {
8550 // Event has been vetoed, set the data back.
8551 SetCellValue(row, col, oldval);
8552 }
8553 }
8554 }
8555 }
8556
8557 //
8558 // ------ Grid location functions
8559 // Note that all of these functions work with the logical coordinates of
8560 // grid cells and labels so you will need to convert from device
8561 // coordinates for mouse events etc.
8562 //
8563
8564 void wxGrid::XYToCell( int x, int y, wxGridCellCoords& coords ) const
8565 {
8566 int row = YToRow(y);
8567 int col = XToCol(x);
8568
8569 if ( row == -1 || col == -1 )
8570 {
8571 coords = wxGridNoCellCoords;
8572 }
8573 else
8574 {
8575 coords.Set( row, col );
8576 }
8577 }
8578
8579 // Internal Helper function for computing row or column from some
8580 // (unscrolled) coordinate value, using either
8581 // m_defaultRowHeight/m_defaultColWidth or binary search on array
8582 // of m_rowBottoms/m_ColRights to speed up the search!
8583
8584 static int CoordToRowOrCol(int coord, int defaultDist, int minDist,
8585 const wxArrayInt& BorderArray, int nMax,
8586 bool clipToMinMax)
8587 {
8588 if (coord < 0)
8589 return clipToMinMax && (nMax > 0) ? 0 : -1;
8590
8591 if (!defaultDist)
8592 defaultDist = 1;
8593
8594 size_t i_max = coord / defaultDist,
8595 i_min = 0;
8596
8597 if (BorderArray.IsEmpty())
8598 {
8599 if ((int) i_max < nMax)
8600 return i_max;
8601 return clipToMinMax ? nMax - 1 : -1;
8602 }
8603
8604 if ( i_max >= BorderArray.GetCount())
8605 {
8606 i_max = BorderArray.GetCount() - 1;
8607 }
8608 else
8609 {
8610 if ( coord >= BorderArray[i_max])
8611 {
8612 i_min = i_max;
8613 if (minDist)
8614 i_max = coord / minDist;
8615 else
8616 i_max = BorderArray.GetCount() - 1;
8617 }
8618
8619 if ( i_max >= BorderArray.GetCount())
8620 i_max = BorderArray.GetCount() - 1;
8621 }
8622
8623 if ( coord >= BorderArray[i_max])
8624 return clipToMinMax ? (int)i_max : -1;
8625 if ( coord < BorderArray[0] )
8626 return 0;
8627
8628 while ( i_max - i_min > 0 )
8629 {
8630 wxCHECK_MSG(BorderArray[i_min] <= coord && coord < BorderArray[i_max],
8631 0, _T("wxGrid: internal error in CoordToRowOrCol"));
8632 if (coord >= BorderArray[ i_max - 1])
8633 return i_max;
8634 else
8635 i_max--;
8636 int median = i_min + (i_max - i_min + 1) / 2;
8637 if (coord < BorderArray[median])
8638 i_max = median;
8639 else
8640 i_min = median;
8641 }
8642
8643 return i_max;
8644 }
8645
8646 int wxGrid::YToRow( int y ) const
8647 {
8648 return CoordToRowOrCol(y, m_defaultRowHeight,
8649 m_minAcceptableRowHeight, m_rowBottoms, m_numRows, false);
8650 }
8651
8652 int wxGrid::XToCol( int x, bool clipToMinMax ) const
8653 {
8654 if (x < 0)
8655 return clipToMinMax && (m_numCols > 0) ? GetColAt( 0 ) : -1;
8656
8657 wxASSERT_MSG(m_defaultColWidth > 0, wxT("Default column width can not be zero"));
8658
8659 int maxPos = x / m_defaultColWidth;
8660 int minPos = 0;
8661
8662 if (m_colRights.IsEmpty())
8663 {
8664 if(maxPos < m_numCols)
8665 return GetColAt( maxPos );
8666 return clipToMinMax ? GetColAt( m_numCols - 1 ) : -1;
8667 }
8668
8669 if ( maxPos >= m_numCols)
8670 maxPos = m_numCols - 1;
8671 else
8672 {
8673 if ( x >= m_colRights[GetColAt( maxPos )])
8674 {
8675 minPos = maxPos;
8676 if (m_minAcceptableColWidth)
8677 maxPos = x / m_minAcceptableColWidth;
8678 else
8679 maxPos = m_numCols - 1;
8680 }
8681 if ( maxPos >= m_numCols)
8682 maxPos = m_numCols - 1;
8683 }
8684
8685 //X is beyond the last column
8686 if ( x >= m_colRights[GetColAt( maxPos )])
8687 return clipToMinMax ? GetColAt( maxPos ) : -1;
8688
8689 //X is before the first column
8690 if ( x < m_colRights[GetColAt( 0 )] )
8691 return GetColAt( 0 );
8692
8693 //Perform a binary search
8694 while ( maxPos - minPos > 0 )
8695 {
8696 wxCHECK_MSG(m_colRights[GetColAt( minPos )] <= x && x < m_colRights[GetColAt( maxPos )],
8697 0, _T("wxGrid: internal error in XToCol"));
8698
8699 if (x >= m_colRights[GetColAt( maxPos - 1 )])
8700 return GetColAt( maxPos );
8701 else
8702 maxPos--;
8703 int median = minPos + (maxPos - minPos + 1) / 2;
8704 if (x < m_colRights[GetColAt( median )])
8705 maxPos = median;
8706 else
8707 minPos = median;
8708 }
8709 return GetColAt( maxPos );
8710 }
8711
8712 // return the row number that that the y coord is near
8713 // the edge of, or -1 if not near an edge.
8714 // coords can only possibly be near an edge if
8715 // (a) the row/column is large enough to still allow for an "inner" area
8716 // that is _not_ nead the edge (i.e., if the height/width is smaller
8717 // than WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE, coords are _never_ considered to be
8718 // near the edge).
8719 // and
8720 // (b) resizing rows/columns (the thing for which edge detection is
8721 // relevant at all) is enabled.
8722 //
8723 int wxGrid::YToEdgeOfRow( int y ) const
8724 {
8725 int i;
8726 i = internalYToRow(y);
8727
8728 if ( GetRowHeight(i) > WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE && CanDragRowSize() )
8729 {
8730 // We know that we are in row i, test whether we are
8731 // close enough to lower or upper border, respectively.
8732 if ( abs(GetRowBottom(i) - y) < WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8733 return i;
8734 else if ( i > 0 && y - GetRowTop(i) < WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8735 return i - 1;
8736 }
8737
8738 return -1;
8739 }
8740
8741 // return the col number that that the x coord is near the edge of, or
8742 // -1 if not near an edge
8743 // See comment at YToEdgeOfRow for conditions on edge detection.
8744 //
8745 int wxGrid::XToEdgeOfCol( int x ) const
8746 {
8747 int i;
8748 i = internalXToCol(x);
8749
8750 if ( GetColWidth(i) > WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE && CanDragColSize() )
8751 {
8752 // We know that we are in column i; test whether we are
8753 // close enough to right or left border, respectively.
8754 if ( abs(GetColRight(i) - x) < WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8755 return i;
8756 else if ( i > 0 && x - GetColLeft(i) < WXGRID_LABEL_EDGE_ZONE )
8757 return i - 1;
8758 }
8759
8760 return -1;
8761 }
8762
8763 wxRect wxGrid::CellToRect( int row, int col ) const
8764 {
8765 wxRect rect( -1, -1, -1, -1 );
8766
8767 if ( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows &&
8768 col >= 0 && col < m_numCols )
8769 {
8770 int i, cell_rows, cell_cols;
8771 rect.width = rect.height = 0;
8772 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8773 // if negative then find multicell owner
8774 if (cell_rows < 0)
8775 row += cell_rows;
8776 if (cell_cols < 0)
8777 col += cell_cols;
8778 GetCellSize( row, col, &cell_rows, &cell_cols );
8779
8780 rect.x = GetColLeft(col);
8781 rect.y = GetRowTop(row);
8782 for (i=col; i < col + cell_cols; i++)
8783 rect.width += GetColWidth(i);
8784 for (i=row; i < row + cell_rows; i++)
8785 rect.height += GetRowHeight(i);
8786 }
8787
8788 // if grid lines are enabled, then the area of the cell is a bit smaller
8789 if (m_gridLinesEnabled)
8790 {
8791 rect.width -= 1;
8792 rect.height -= 1;
8793 }
8794
8795 return rect;
8796 }
8797
8798 bool wxGrid::IsVisible( int row, int col, bool wholeCellVisible ) const
8799 {
8800 // get the cell rectangle in logical coords
8801 //
8802 wxRect r( CellToRect( row, col ) );
8803
8804 // convert to device coords
8805 //
8806 int left, top, right, bottom;
8807 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), r.GetTop(), &left, &top );
8808 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), r.GetBottom(), &right, &bottom );
8809
8810 // check against the client area of the grid window
8811 int cw, ch;
8812 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
8813
8814 if ( wholeCellVisible )
8815 {
8816 // is the cell wholly visible ?
8817 return ( left >= 0 && right <= cw &&
8818 top >= 0 && bottom <= ch );
8819 }
8820 else
8821 {
8822 // is the cell partly visible ?
8823 //
8824 return ( ((left >= 0 && left < cw) || (right > 0 && right <= cw)) &&
8825 ((top >= 0 && top < ch) || (bottom > 0 && bottom <= ch)) );
8826 }
8827 }
8828
8829 // make the specified cell location visible by doing a minimal amount
8830 // of scrolling
8831 //
8832 void wxGrid::MakeCellVisible( int row, int col )
8833 {
8834 int i;
8835 int xpos = -1, ypos = -1;
8836
8837 if ( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows &&
8838 col >= 0 && col < m_numCols )
8839 {
8840 // get the cell rectangle in logical coords
8841 wxRect r( CellToRect( row, col ) );
8842
8843 // convert to device coords
8844 int left, top, right, bottom;
8845 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetLeft(), r.GetTop(), &left, &top );
8846 CalcScrolledPosition( r.GetRight(), r.GetBottom(), &right, &bottom );
8847
8848 int cw, ch;
8849 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
8850
8851 if ( top < 0 )
8852 {
8853 ypos = r.GetTop();
8854 }
8855 else if ( bottom > ch )
8856 {
8857 int h = r.GetHeight();
8858 ypos = r.GetTop();
8859 for ( i = row - 1; i >= 0; i-- )
8860 {
8861 int rowHeight = GetRowHeight(i);
8862 if ( h + rowHeight > ch )
8863 break;
8864
8865 h += rowHeight;
8866 ypos -= rowHeight;
8867 }
8868
8869 // we divide it later by GRID_SCROLL_LINE, make sure that we don't
8870 // have rounding errors (this is important, because if we do,
8871 // we might not scroll at all and some cells won't be redrawn)
8872 //
8873 // Sometimes GRID_SCROLL_LINE / 2 is not enough,
8874 // so just add a full scroll unit...
8875 ypos += m_scrollLineY;
8876 }
8877
8878 // special handling for wide cells - show always left part of the cell!
8879 // Otherwise, e.g. when stepping from row to row, it would jump between
8880 // left and right part of the cell on every step!
8881 // if ( left < 0 )
8882 if ( left < 0 || (right - left) >= cw )
8883 {
8884 xpos = r.GetLeft();
8885 }
8886 else if ( right > cw )
8887 {
8888 // position the view so that the cell is on the right
8889 int x0, y0;
8890 CalcUnscrolledPosition(0, 0, &x0, &y0);
8891 xpos = x0 + (right - cw);
8892
8893 // see comment for ypos above
8894 xpos += m_scrollLineX;
8895 }
8896
8897 if ( xpos != -1 || ypos != -1 )
8898 {
8899 if ( xpos != -1 )
8900 xpos /= m_scrollLineX;
8901 if ( ypos != -1 )
8902 ypos /= m_scrollLineY;
8903 Scroll( xpos, ypos );
8904 AdjustScrollbars();
8905 }
8906 }
8907 }
8908
8909 //
8910 // ------ Grid cursor movement functions
8911 //
8912
8913 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorUp( bool expandSelection )
8914 {
8915 if ( m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
8916 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() >= 0 )
8917 {
8918 if ( expandSelection )
8919 {
8920 if ( m_selectingKeyboard == wxGridNoCellCoords )
8921 m_selectingKeyboard = m_currentCellCoords;
8922 if ( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow() > 0 )
8923 {
8924 m_selectingKeyboard.SetRow( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow() - 1 );
8925 MakeCellVisible( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow(),
8926 m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() );
8927 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
8928 }
8929 }
8930 else if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() > 0 )
8931 {
8932 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() - 1;
8933 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8934 ClearSelection();
8935 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
8936 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
8937 }
8938 else
8939 return false;
8940
8941 return true;
8942 }
8943
8944 return false;
8945 }
8946
8947 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorDown( bool expandSelection )
8948 {
8949 if ( m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
8950 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() < m_numRows )
8951 {
8952 if ( expandSelection )
8953 {
8954 if ( m_selectingKeyboard == wxGridNoCellCoords )
8955 m_selectingKeyboard = m_currentCellCoords;
8956 if ( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow() < m_numRows - 1 )
8957 {
8958 m_selectingKeyboard.SetRow( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow() + 1 );
8959 MakeCellVisible( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow(),
8960 m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() );
8961 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
8962 }
8963 }
8964 else if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() < m_numRows - 1 )
8965 {
8966 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() + 1;
8967 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
8968 ClearSelection();
8969 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
8970 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
8971 }
8972 else
8973 return false;
8974
8975 return true;
8976 }
8977
8978 return false;
8979 }
8980
8981 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorLeft( bool expandSelection )
8982 {
8983 if ( m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
8984 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() >= 0 )
8985 {
8986 if ( expandSelection )
8987 {
8988 if ( m_selectingKeyboard == wxGridNoCellCoords )
8989 m_selectingKeyboard = m_currentCellCoords;
8990 if ( m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() > 0 )
8991 {
8992 m_selectingKeyboard.SetCol( m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() - 1 );
8993 MakeCellVisible( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow(),
8994 m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() );
8995 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
8996 }
8997 }
8998 else if ( GetColPos( m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() ) > 0 )
8999 {
9000 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9001 int col = GetColAt( GetColPos( m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() ) - 1 );
9002 ClearSelection();
9003
9004 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
9005 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
9006 }
9007 else
9008 return false;
9009
9010 return true;
9011 }
9012
9013 return false;
9014 }
9015
9016 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorRight( bool expandSelection )
9017 {
9018 if ( m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
9019 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() < m_numCols )
9020 {
9021 if ( expandSelection )
9022 {
9023 if ( m_selectingKeyboard == wxGridNoCellCoords )
9024 m_selectingKeyboard = m_currentCellCoords;
9025 if ( m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() < m_numCols - 1 )
9026 {
9027 m_selectingKeyboard.SetCol( m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() + 1 );
9028 MakeCellVisible( m_selectingKeyboard.GetRow(),
9029 m_selectingKeyboard.GetCol() );
9030 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
9031 }
9032 }
9033 else if ( GetColPos( m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() ) < m_numCols - 1 )
9034 {
9035 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9036 int col = GetColAt( GetColPos( m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() ) + 1 );
9037 ClearSelection();
9038
9039 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
9040 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
9041 }
9042 else
9043 return false;
9044
9045 return true;
9046 }
9047
9048 return false;
9049 }
9050
9051 bool wxGrid::MovePageUp()
9052 {
9053 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
9054 return false;
9055
9056 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9057 if ( row > 0 )
9058 {
9059 int cw, ch;
9060 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
9061
9062 int y = GetRowTop(row);
9063 int newRow = internalYToRow( y - ch + 1 );
9064
9065 if ( newRow == row )
9066 {
9067 // row > 0, so newRow can never be less than 0 here.
9068 newRow = row - 1;
9069 }
9070
9071 MakeCellVisible( newRow, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() );
9072 SetCurrentCell( newRow, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() );
9073
9074 return true;
9075 }
9076
9077 return false;
9078 }
9079
9080 bool wxGrid::MovePageDown()
9081 {
9082 if ( m_currentCellCoords == wxGridNoCellCoords )
9083 return false;
9084
9085 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9086 if ( (row + 1) < m_numRows )
9087 {
9088 int cw, ch;
9089 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
9090
9091 int y = GetRowTop(row);
9092 int newRow = internalYToRow( y + ch );
9093 if ( newRow == row )
9094 {
9095 // row < m_numRows, so newRow can't overflow here.
9096 newRow = row + 1;
9097 }
9098
9099 MakeCellVisible( newRow, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() );
9100 SetCurrentCell( newRow, m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() );
9101
9102 return true;
9103 }
9104
9105 return false;
9106 }
9107
9108 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorUpBlock( bool expandSelection )
9109 {
9110 if ( m_table &&
9111 m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
9112 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() > 0 )
9113 {
9114 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9115 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9116
9117 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9118 {
9119 // starting in an empty cell: find the next block of
9120 // non-empty cells
9121 //
9122 while ( row > 0 )
9123 {
9124 row--;
9125 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9126 break;
9127 }
9128 }
9129 else if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row - 1, col) )
9130 {
9131 // starting at the top of a block: find the next block
9132 //
9133 row--;
9134 while ( row > 0 )
9135 {
9136 row--;
9137 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9138 break;
9139 }
9140 }
9141 else
9142 {
9143 // starting within a block: find the top of the block
9144 //
9145 while ( row > 0 )
9146 {
9147 row--;
9148 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9149 {
9150 row++;
9151 break;
9152 }
9153 }
9154 }
9155
9156 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
9157 if ( expandSelection )
9158 {
9159 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridCellCoords( row, col );
9160 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
9161 }
9162 else
9163 {
9164 ClearSelection();
9165 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
9166 }
9167
9168 return true;
9169 }
9170
9171 return false;
9172 }
9173
9174 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorDownBlock( bool expandSelection )
9175 {
9176 if ( m_table &&
9177 m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
9178 m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() < m_numRows - 1 )
9179 {
9180 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9181 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9182
9183 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9184 {
9185 // starting in an empty cell: find the next block of
9186 // non-empty cells
9187 //
9188 while ( row < m_numRows - 1 )
9189 {
9190 row++;
9191 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9192 break;
9193 }
9194 }
9195 else if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row + 1, col) )
9196 {
9197 // starting at the bottom of a block: find the next block
9198 //
9199 row++;
9200 while ( row < m_numRows - 1 )
9201 {
9202 row++;
9203 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9204 break;
9205 }
9206 }
9207 else
9208 {
9209 // starting within a block: find the bottom of the block
9210 //
9211 while ( row < m_numRows - 1 )
9212 {
9213 row++;
9214 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9215 {
9216 row--;
9217 break;
9218 }
9219 }
9220 }
9221
9222 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
9223 if ( expandSelection )
9224 {
9225 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridCellCoords( row, col );
9226 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
9227 }
9228 else
9229 {
9230 ClearSelection();
9231 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
9232 }
9233
9234 return true;
9235 }
9236
9237 return false;
9238 }
9239
9240 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorLeftBlock( bool expandSelection )
9241 {
9242 if ( m_table &&
9243 m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
9244 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() > 0 )
9245 {
9246 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9247 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9248
9249 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9250 {
9251 // starting in an empty cell: find the next block of
9252 // non-empty cells
9253 //
9254 while ( col > 0 )
9255 {
9256 col--;
9257 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9258 break;
9259 }
9260 }
9261 else if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col - 1) )
9262 {
9263 // starting at the left of a block: find the next block
9264 //
9265 col--;
9266 while ( col > 0 )
9267 {
9268 col--;
9269 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9270 break;
9271 }
9272 }
9273 else
9274 {
9275 // starting within a block: find the left of the block
9276 //
9277 while ( col > 0 )
9278 {
9279 col--;
9280 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9281 {
9282 col++;
9283 break;
9284 }
9285 }
9286 }
9287
9288 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
9289 if ( expandSelection )
9290 {
9291 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridCellCoords( row, col );
9292 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
9293 }
9294 else
9295 {
9296 ClearSelection();
9297 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
9298 }
9299
9300 return true;
9301 }
9302
9303 return false;
9304 }
9305
9306 bool wxGrid::MoveCursorRightBlock( bool expandSelection )
9307 {
9308 if ( m_table &&
9309 m_currentCellCoords != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
9310 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() < m_numCols - 1 )
9311 {
9312 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9313 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9314
9315 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9316 {
9317 // starting in an empty cell: find the next block of
9318 // non-empty cells
9319 //
9320 while ( col < m_numCols - 1 )
9321 {
9322 col++;
9323 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9324 break;
9325 }
9326 }
9327 else if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col + 1) )
9328 {
9329 // starting at the right of a block: find the next block
9330 //
9331 col++;
9332 while ( col < m_numCols - 1 )
9333 {
9334 col++;
9335 if ( !(m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col)) )
9336 break;
9337 }
9338 }
9339 else
9340 {
9341 // starting within a block: find the right of the block
9342 //
9343 while ( col < m_numCols - 1 )
9344 {
9345 col++;
9346 if ( m_table->IsEmptyCell(row, col) )
9347 {
9348 col--;
9349 break;
9350 }
9351 }
9352 }
9353
9354 MakeCellVisible( row, col );
9355 if ( expandSelection )
9356 {
9357 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridCellCoords( row, col );
9358 HighlightBlock( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
9359 }
9360 else
9361 {
9362 ClearSelection();
9363 SetCurrentCell( row, col );
9364 }
9365
9366 return true;
9367 }
9368
9369 return false;
9370 }
9371
9372 //
9373 // ------ Label values and formatting
9374 //
9375
9376 void wxGrid::GetRowLabelAlignment( int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9377 {
9378 if ( horiz )
9379 *horiz = m_rowLabelHorizAlign;
9380 if ( vert )
9381 *vert = m_rowLabelVertAlign;
9382 }
9383
9384 void wxGrid::GetColLabelAlignment( int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9385 {
9386 if ( horiz )
9387 *horiz = m_colLabelHorizAlign;
9388 if ( vert )
9389 *vert = m_colLabelVertAlign;
9390 }
9391
9392 int wxGrid::GetColLabelTextOrientation() const
9393 {
9394 return m_colLabelTextOrientation;
9395 }
9396
9397 wxString wxGrid::GetRowLabelValue( int row ) const
9398 {
9399 if ( m_table )
9400 {
9401 return m_table->GetRowLabelValue( row );
9402 }
9403 else
9404 {
9405 wxString s;
9406 s << row;
9407 return s;
9408 }
9409 }
9410
9411 wxString wxGrid::GetColLabelValue( int col ) const
9412 {
9413 if ( m_table )
9414 {
9415 return m_table->GetColLabelValue( col );
9416 }
9417 else
9418 {
9419 wxString s;
9420 s << col;
9421 return s;
9422 }
9423 }
9424
9425 void wxGrid::SetRowLabelSize( int width )
9426 {
9427 wxASSERT( width >= 0 || width == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE );
9428
9429 if ( width == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE )
9430 {
9431 width = CalcColOrRowLabelAreaMinSize(wxGRID_ROW);
9432 }
9433
9434 if ( width != m_rowLabelWidth )
9435 {
9436 if ( width == 0 )
9437 {
9438 m_rowLabelWin->Show( false );
9439 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( false );
9440 }
9441 else if ( m_rowLabelWidth == 0 )
9442 {
9443 m_rowLabelWin->Show( true );
9444 if ( m_colLabelHeight > 0 )
9445 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( true );
9446 }
9447
9448 m_rowLabelWidth = width;
9449 CalcWindowSizes();
9450 wxScrolledWindow::Refresh( true );
9451 }
9452 }
9453
9454 void wxGrid::SetColLabelSize( int height )
9455 {
9456 wxASSERT( height >=0 || height == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE );
9457
9458 if ( height == wxGRID_AUTOSIZE )
9459 {
9460 height = CalcColOrRowLabelAreaMinSize(wxGRID_COLUMN);
9461 }
9462
9463 if ( height != m_colLabelHeight )
9464 {
9465 if ( height == 0 )
9466 {
9467 m_colLabelWin->Show( false );
9468 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( false );
9469 }
9470 else if ( m_colLabelHeight == 0 )
9471 {
9472 m_colLabelWin->Show( true );
9473 if ( m_rowLabelWidth > 0 )
9474 m_cornerLabelWin->Show( true );
9475 }
9476
9477 m_colLabelHeight = height;
9478 CalcWindowSizes();
9479 wxScrolledWindow::Refresh( true );
9480 }
9481 }
9482
9483 void wxGrid::SetLabelBackgroundColour( const wxColour& colour )
9484 {
9485 if ( m_labelBackgroundColour != colour )
9486 {
9487 m_labelBackgroundColour = colour;
9488 m_rowLabelWin->SetBackgroundColour( colour );
9489 m_colLabelWin->SetBackgroundColour( colour );
9490 m_cornerLabelWin->SetBackgroundColour( colour );
9491
9492 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9493 {
9494 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9495 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9496 m_cornerLabelWin->Refresh();
9497 }
9498 }
9499 }
9500
9501 void wxGrid::SetLabelTextColour( const wxColour& colour )
9502 {
9503 if ( m_labelTextColour != colour )
9504 {
9505 m_labelTextColour = colour;
9506 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9507 {
9508 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9509 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9510 }
9511 }
9512 }
9513
9514 void wxGrid::SetLabelFont( const wxFont& font )
9515 {
9516 m_labelFont = font;
9517 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9518 {
9519 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9520 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9521 }
9522 }
9523
9524 void wxGrid::SetRowLabelAlignment( int horiz, int vert )
9525 {
9526 // allow old (incorrect) defs to be used
9527 switch ( horiz )
9528 {
9529 case wxLEFT: horiz = wxALIGN_LEFT; break;
9530 case wxRIGHT: horiz = wxALIGN_RIGHT; break;
9531 case wxCENTRE: horiz = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9532 }
9533
9534 switch ( vert )
9535 {
9536 case wxTOP: vert = wxALIGN_TOP; break;
9537 case wxBOTTOM: vert = wxALIGN_BOTTOM; break;
9538 case wxCENTRE: vert = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9539 }
9540
9541 if ( horiz == wxALIGN_LEFT || horiz == wxALIGN_CENTRE || horiz == wxALIGN_RIGHT )
9542 {
9543 m_rowLabelHorizAlign = horiz;
9544 }
9545
9546 if ( vert == wxALIGN_TOP || vert == wxALIGN_CENTRE || vert == wxALIGN_BOTTOM )
9547 {
9548 m_rowLabelVertAlign = vert;
9549 }
9550
9551 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9552 {
9553 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh();
9554 }
9555 }
9556
9557 void wxGrid::SetColLabelAlignment( int horiz, int vert )
9558 {
9559 // allow old (incorrect) defs to be used
9560 switch ( horiz )
9561 {
9562 case wxLEFT: horiz = wxALIGN_LEFT; break;
9563 case wxRIGHT: horiz = wxALIGN_RIGHT; break;
9564 case wxCENTRE: horiz = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9565 }
9566
9567 switch ( vert )
9568 {
9569 case wxTOP: vert = wxALIGN_TOP; break;
9570 case wxBOTTOM: vert = wxALIGN_BOTTOM; break;
9571 case wxCENTRE: vert = wxALIGN_CENTRE; break;
9572 }
9573
9574 if ( horiz == wxALIGN_LEFT || horiz == wxALIGN_CENTRE || horiz == wxALIGN_RIGHT )
9575 {
9576 m_colLabelHorizAlign = horiz;
9577 }
9578
9579 if ( vert == wxALIGN_TOP || vert == wxALIGN_CENTRE || vert == wxALIGN_BOTTOM )
9580 {
9581 m_colLabelVertAlign = vert;
9582 }
9583
9584 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9585 {
9586 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9587 }
9588 }
9589
9590 // Note: under MSW, the default column label font must be changed because it
9591 // does not support vertical printing
9592 //
9593 // Example: wxFont font(9, wxSWISS, wxNORMAL, wxBOLD);
9594 // pGrid->SetLabelFont(font);
9595 // pGrid->SetColLabelTextOrientation(wxVERTICAL);
9596 //
9597 void wxGrid::SetColLabelTextOrientation( int textOrientation )
9598 {
9599 if ( textOrientation == wxHORIZONTAL || textOrientation == wxVERTICAL )
9600 m_colLabelTextOrientation = textOrientation;
9601
9602 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9603 m_colLabelWin->Refresh();
9604 }
9605
9606 void wxGrid::SetRowLabelValue( int row, const wxString& s )
9607 {
9608 if ( m_table )
9609 {
9610 m_table->SetRowLabelValue( row, s );
9611 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9612 {
9613 wxRect rect = CellToRect( row, 0 );
9614 if ( rect.height > 0 )
9615 {
9616 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &rect.x, &rect.y);
9617 rect.x = 0;
9618 rect.width = m_rowLabelWidth;
9619 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
9620 }
9621 }
9622 }
9623 }
9624
9625 void wxGrid::SetColLabelValue( int col, const wxString& s )
9626 {
9627 if ( m_table )
9628 {
9629 m_table->SetColLabelValue( col, s );
9630 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9631 {
9632 wxRect rect = CellToRect( 0, col );
9633 if ( rect.width > 0 )
9634 {
9635 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, 0, &rect.x, &rect.y);
9636 rect.y = 0;
9637 rect.height = m_colLabelHeight;
9638 m_colLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
9639 }
9640 }
9641 }
9642 }
9643
9644 void wxGrid::SetGridLineColour( const wxColour& colour )
9645 {
9646 if ( m_gridLineColour != colour )
9647 {
9648 m_gridLineColour = colour;
9649
9650 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
9651 PrepareDC( dc );
9652 DrawAllGridLines( dc, wxRegion() );
9653 }
9654 }
9655
9656 void wxGrid::SetCellHighlightColour( const wxColour& colour )
9657 {
9658 if ( m_cellHighlightColour != colour )
9659 {
9660 m_cellHighlightColour = colour;
9661
9662 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
9663 PrepareDC( dc );
9664 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(m_currentCellCoords);
9665 DrawCellHighlight(dc, attr);
9666 attr->DecRef();
9667 }
9668 }
9669
9670 void wxGrid::SetCellHighlightPenWidth(int width)
9671 {
9672 if (m_cellHighlightPenWidth != width)
9673 {
9674 m_cellHighlightPenWidth = width;
9675
9676 // Just redrawing the cell highlight is not enough since that won't
9677 // make any visible change if the the thickness is getting smaller.
9678 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9679 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9680 if ( row == -1 || col == -1 || GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
9681 return;
9682
9683 wxRect rect = CellToRect(row, col);
9684 m_gridWin->Refresh(true, &rect);
9685 }
9686 }
9687
9688 void wxGrid::SetCellHighlightROPenWidth(int width)
9689 {
9690 if (m_cellHighlightROPenWidth != width)
9691 {
9692 m_cellHighlightROPenWidth = width;
9693
9694 // Just redrawing the cell highlight is not enough since that won't
9695 // make any visible change if the the thickness is getting smaller.
9696 int row = m_currentCellCoords.GetRow();
9697 int col = m_currentCellCoords.GetCol();
9698 if ( row == -1 || col == -1 ||
9699 GetColWidth(col) <= 0 || GetRowHeight(row) <= 0 )
9700 return;
9701
9702 wxRect rect = CellToRect(row, col);
9703 m_gridWin->Refresh(true, &rect);
9704 }
9705 }
9706
9707 void wxGrid::EnableGridLines( bool enable )
9708 {
9709 if ( enable != m_gridLinesEnabled )
9710 {
9711 m_gridLinesEnabled = enable;
9712
9713 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
9714 {
9715 if ( enable )
9716 {
9717 wxClientDC dc( m_gridWin );
9718 PrepareDC( dc );
9719 DrawAllGridLines( dc, wxRegion() );
9720 }
9721 else
9722 {
9723 m_gridWin->Refresh();
9724 }
9725 }
9726 }
9727 }
9728
9729 int wxGrid::GetDefaultRowSize() const
9730 {
9731 return m_defaultRowHeight;
9732 }
9733
9734 int wxGrid::GetRowSize( int row ) const
9735 {
9736 wxCHECK_MSG( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows, 0, _T("invalid row index") );
9737
9738 return GetRowHeight(row);
9739 }
9740
9741 int wxGrid::GetDefaultColSize() const
9742 {
9743 return m_defaultColWidth;
9744 }
9745
9746 int wxGrid::GetColSize( int col ) const
9747 {
9748 wxCHECK_MSG( col >= 0 && col < m_numCols, 0, _T("invalid column index") );
9749
9750 return GetColWidth(col);
9751 }
9752
9753 // ============================================================================
9754 // access to the grid attributes: each of them has a default value in the grid
9755 // itself and may be overidden on a per-cell basis
9756 // ============================================================================
9757
9758 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9759 // setting default attributes
9760 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9761
9762 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellBackgroundColour( const wxColour& col )
9763 {
9764 m_defaultCellAttr->SetBackgroundColour(col);
9765 #ifdef __WXGTK__
9766 m_gridWin->SetBackgroundColour(col);
9767 #endif
9768 }
9769
9770 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellTextColour( const wxColour& col )
9771 {
9772 m_defaultCellAttr->SetTextColour(col);
9773 }
9774
9775 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellAlignment( int horiz, int vert )
9776 {
9777 m_defaultCellAttr->SetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9778 }
9779
9780 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellOverflow( bool allow )
9781 {
9782 m_defaultCellAttr->SetOverflow(allow);
9783 }
9784
9785 void wxGrid::SetDefaultCellFont( const wxFont& font )
9786 {
9787 m_defaultCellAttr->SetFont(font);
9788 }
9789
9790 // For editors and renderers the type registry takes precedence over the
9791 // default attr, so we need to register the new editor/renderer for the string
9792 // data type in order to make setting a default editor/renderer appear to
9793 // work correctly.
9794
9795 void wxGrid::SetDefaultRenderer(wxGridCellRenderer *renderer)
9796 {
9797 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING,
9798 renderer,
9799 GetDefaultEditorForType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING));
9800 }
9801
9802 void wxGrid::SetDefaultEditor(wxGridCellEditor *editor)
9803 {
9804 RegisterDataType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING,
9805 GetDefaultRendererForType(wxGRID_VALUE_STRING),
9806 editor);
9807 }
9808
9809 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9810 // access to the default attributes
9811 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9812
9813 wxColour wxGrid::GetDefaultCellBackgroundColour() const
9814 {
9815 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetBackgroundColour();
9816 }
9817
9818 wxColour wxGrid::GetDefaultCellTextColour() const
9819 {
9820 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetTextColour();
9821 }
9822
9823 wxFont wxGrid::GetDefaultCellFont() const
9824 {
9825 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetFont();
9826 }
9827
9828 void wxGrid::GetDefaultCellAlignment( int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9829 {
9830 m_defaultCellAttr->GetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9831 }
9832
9833 bool wxGrid::GetDefaultCellOverflow() const
9834 {
9835 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetOverflow();
9836 }
9837
9838 wxGridCellRenderer *wxGrid::GetDefaultRenderer() const
9839 {
9840 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetRenderer(NULL, 0, 0);
9841 }
9842
9843 wxGridCellEditor *wxGrid::GetDefaultEditor() const
9844 {
9845 return m_defaultCellAttr->GetEditor(NULL, 0, 0);
9846 }
9847
9848 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9849 // access to cell attributes
9850 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9851
9852 wxColour wxGrid::GetCellBackgroundColour(int row, int col) const
9853 {
9854 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9855 wxColour colour = attr->GetBackgroundColour();
9856 attr->DecRef();
9857
9858 return colour;
9859 }
9860
9861 wxColour wxGrid::GetCellTextColour( int row, int col ) const
9862 {
9863 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9864 wxColour colour = attr->GetTextColour();
9865 attr->DecRef();
9866
9867 return colour;
9868 }
9869
9870 wxFont wxGrid::GetCellFont( int row, int col ) const
9871 {
9872 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9873 wxFont font = attr->GetFont();
9874 attr->DecRef();
9875
9876 return font;
9877 }
9878
9879 void wxGrid::GetCellAlignment( int row, int col, int *horiz, int *vert ) const
9880 {
9881 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9882 attr->GetAlignment(horiz, vert);
9883 attr->DecRef();
9884 }
9885
9886 bool wxGrid::GetCellOverflow( int row, int col ) const
9887 {
9888 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9889 bool allow = attr->GetOverflow();
9890 attr->DecRef();
9891
9892 return allow;
9893 }
9894
9895 void wxGrid::GetCellSize( int row, int col, int *num_rows, int *num_cols ) const
9896 {
9897 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9898 attr->GetSize( num_rows, num_cols );
9899 attr->DecRef();
9900 }
9901
9902 wxGridCellRenderer* wxGrid::GetCellRenderer(int row, int col) const
9903 {
9904 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9905 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer = attr->GetRenderer(this, row, col);
9906 attr->DecRef();
9907
9908 return renderer;
9909 }
9910
9911 wxGridCellEditor* wxGrid::GetCellEditor(int row, int col) const
9912 {
9913 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9914 wxGridCellEditor* editor = attr->GetEditor(this, row, col);
9915 attr->DecRef();
9916
9917 return editor;
9918 }
9919
9920 bool wxGrid::IsReadOnly(int row, int col) const
9921 {
9922 wxGridCellAttr* attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
9923 bool isReadOnly = attr->IsReadOnly();
9924 attr->DecRef();
9925
9926 return isReadOnly;
9927 }
9928
9929 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9930 // attribute support: cache, automatic provider creation, ...
9931 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
9932
9933 bool wxGrid::CanHaveAttributes() const
9934 {
9935 if ( !m_table )
9936 {
9937 return false;
9938 }
9939
9940 return m_table->CanHaveAttributes();
9941 }
9942
9943 void wxGrid::ClearAttrCache()
9944 {
9945 if ( m_attrCache.row != -1 )
9946 {
9947 wxGridCellAttr *oldAttr = m_attrCache.attr;
9948 m_attrCache.attr = NULL;
9949 m_attrCache.row = -1;
9950 // wxSafeDecRec(...) might cause event processing that accesses
9951 // the cached attribute, if one exists (e.g. by deleting the
9952 // editor stored within the attribute). Therefore it is important
9953 // to invalidate the cache before calling wxSafeDecRef!
9954 wxSafeDecRef(oldAttr);
9955 }
9956 }
9957
9958 void wxGrid::CacheAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr) const
9959 {
9960 if ( attr != NULL )
9961 {
9962 wxGrid *self = (wxGrid *)this; // const_cast
9963
9964 self->ClearAttrCache();
9965 self->m_attrCache.row = row;
9966 self->m_attrCache.col = col;
9967 self->m_attrCache.attr = attr;
9968 wxSafeIncRef(attr);
9969 }
9970 }
9971
9972 bool wxGrid::LookupAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr **attr) const
9973 {
9974 if ( row == m_attrCache.row && col == m_attrCache.col )
9975 {
9976 *attr = m_attrCache.attr;
9977 wxSafeIncRef(m_attrCache.attr);
9978
9979 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
9980 gs_nAttrCacheHits++;
9981 #endif
9982
9983 return true;
9984 }
9985 else
9986 {
9987 #ifdef DEBUG_ATTR_CACHE
9988 gs_nAttrCacheMisses++;
9989 #endif
9990
9991 return false;
9992 }
9993 }
9994
9995 wxGridCellAttr *wxGrid::GetCellAttr(int row, int col) const
9996 {
9997 wxGridCellAttr *attr = NULL;
9998 // Additional test to avoid looking at the cache e.g. for
9999 // wxNoCellCoords, as this will confuse memory management.
10000 if ( row >= 0 )
10001 {
10002 if ( !LookupAttr(row, col, &attr) )
10003 {
10004 attr = m_table ? m_table->GetAttr(row, col, wxGridCellAttr::Any)
10005 : (wxGridCellAttr *)NULL;
10006 CacheAttr(row, col, attr);
10007 }
10008 }
10009
10010 if (attr)
10011 {
10012 attr->SetDefAttr(m_defaultCellAttr);
10013 }
10014 else
10015 {
10016 attr = m_defaultCellAttr;
10017 attr->IncRef();
10018 }
10019
10020 return attr;
10021 }
10022
10023 wxGridCellAttr *wxGrid::GetOrCreateCellAttr(int row, int col) const
10024 {
10025 wxGridCellAttr *attr = (wxGridCellAttr *)NULL;
10026 bool canHave = ((wxGrid*)this)->CanHaveAttributes();
10027
10028 wxCHECK_MSG( canHave, attr, _T("Cell attributes not allowed"));
10029 wxCHECK_MSG( m_table, attr, _T("must have a table") );
10030
10031 attr = m_table->GetAttr(row, col, wxGridCellAttr::Cell);
10032 if ( !attr )
10033 {
10034 attr = new wxGridCellAttr(m_defaultCellAttr);
10035
10036 // artificially inc the ref count to match DecRef() in caller
10037 attr->IncRef();
10038 m_table->SetAttr(attr, row, col);
10039 }
10040
10041 return attr;
10042 }
10043
10044 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10045 // setting column attributes (wrappers around SetColAttr)
10046 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10047
10048 void wxGrid::SetColFormatBool(int col)
10049 {
10050 SetColFormatCustom(col, wxGRID_VALUE_BOOL);
10051 }
10052
10053 void wxGrid::SetColFormatNumber(int col)
10054 {
10055 SetColFormatCustom(col, wxGRID_VALUE_NUMBER);
10056 }
10057
10058 void wxGrid::SetColFormatFloat(int col, int width, int precision)
10059 {
10060 wxString typeName = wxGRID_VALUE_FLOAT;
10061 if ( (width != -1) || (precision != -1) )
10062 {
10063 typeName << _T(':') << width << _T(',') << precision;
10064 }
10065
10066 SetColFormatCustom(col, typeName);
10067 }
10068
10069 void wxGrid::SetColFormatCustom(int col, const wxString& typeName)
10070 {
10071 wxGridCellAttr *attr = m_table->GetAttr(-1, col, wxGridCellAttr::Col );
10072 if (!attr)
10073 attr = new wxGridCellAttr;
10074 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = GetDefaultRendererForType(typeName);
10075 attr->SetRenderer(renderer);
10076 wxGridCellEditor *editor = GetDefaultEditorForType(typeName);
10077 attr->SetEditor(editor);
10078
10079 SetColAttr(col, attr);
10080
10081 }
10082
10083 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10084 // setting cell attributes: this is forwarded to the table
10085 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10086
10087 void wxGrid::SetAttr(int row, int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
10088 {
10089 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10090 {
10091 m_table->SetAttr(attr, row, col);
10092 ClearAttrCache();
10093 }
10094 else
10095 {
10096 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
10097 }
10098 }
10099
10100 void wxGrid::SetRowAttr(int row, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
10101 {
10102 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10103 {
10104 m_table->SetRowAttr(attr, row);
10105 ClearAttrCache();
10106 }
10107 else
10108 {
10109 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
10110 }
10111 }
10112
10113 void wxGrid::SetColAttr(int col, wxGridCellAttr *attr)
10114 {
10115 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10116 {
10117 m_table->SetColAttr(attr, col);
10118 ClearAttrCache();
10119 }
10120 else
10121 {
10122 wxSafeDecRef(attr);
10123 }
10124 }
10125
10126 void wxGrid::SetCellBackgroundColour( int row, int col, const wxColour& colour )
10127 {
10128 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10129 {
10130 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10131 attr->SetBackgroundColour(colour);
10132 attr->DecRef();
10133 }
10134 }
10135
10136 void wxGrid::SetCellTextColour( int row, int col, const wxColour& colour )
10137 {
10138 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10139 {
10140 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10141 attr->SetTextColour(colour);
10142 attr->DecRef();
10143 }
10144 }
10145
10146 void wxGrid::SetCellFont( int row, int col, const wxFont& font )
10147 {
10148 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10149 {
10150 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10151 attr->SetFont(font);
10152 attr->DecRef();
10153 }
10154 }
10155
10156 void wxGrid::SetCellAlignment( int row, int col, int horiz, int vert )
10157 {
10158 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10159 {
10160 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10161 attr->SetAlignment(horiz, vert);
10162 attr->DecRef();
10163 }
10164 }
10165
10166 void wxGrid::SetCellOverflow( int row, int col, bool allow )
10167 {
10168 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10169 {
10170 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10171 attr->SetOverflow(allow);
10172 attr->DecRef();
10173 }
10174 }
10175
10176 void wxGrid::SetCellSize( int row, int col, int num_rows, int num_cols )
10177 {
10178 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10179 {
10180 int cell_rows, cell_cols;
10181
10182 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10183 attr->GetSize(&cell_rows, &cell_cols);
10184 attr->SetSize(num_rows, num_cols);
10185 attr->DecRef();
10186
10187 // Cannot set the size of a cell to 0 or negative values
10188 // While it is perfectly legal to do that, this function cannot
10189 // handle all the possibilies, do it by hand by getting the CellAttr.
10190 // You can only set the size of a cell to 1,1 or greater with this fn
10191 wxASSERT_MSG( !((cell_rows < 1) || (cell_cols < 1)),
10192 wxT("wxGrid::SetCellSize setting cell size that is already part of another cell"));
10193 wxASSERT_MSG( !((num_rows < 1) || (num_cols < 1)),
10194 wxT("wxGrid::SetCellSize setting cell size to < 1"));
10195
10196 // if this was already a multicell then "turn off" the other cells first
10197 if ((cell_rows > 1) || (cell_cols > 1))
10198 {
10199 int i, j;
10200 for (j=row; j < row + cell_rows; j++)
10201 {
10202 for (i=col; i < col + cell_cols; i++)
10203 {
10204 if ((i != col) || (j != row))
10205 {
10206 wxGridCellAttr *attr_stub = GetOrCreateCellAttr(j, i);
10207 attr_stub->SetSize( 1, 1 );
10208 attr_stub->DecRef();
10209 }
10210 }
10211 }
10212 }
10213
10214 // mark the cells that will be covered by this cell to
10215 // negative or zero values to point back at this cell
10216 if (((num_rows > 1) || (num_cols > 1)) && (num_rows >= 1) && (num_cols >= 1))
10217 {
10218 int i, j;
10219 for (j=row; j < row + num_rows; j++)
10220 {
10221 for (i=col; i < col + num_cols; i++)
10222 {
10223 if ((i != col) || (j != row))
10224 {
10225 wxGridCellAttr *attr_stub = GetOrCreateCellAttr(j, i);
10226 attr_stub->SetSize( row - j, col - i );
10227 attr_stub->DecRef();
10228 }
10229 }
10230 }
10231 }
10232 }
10233 }
10234
10235 void wxGrid::SetCellRenderer(int row, int col, wxGridCellRenderer *renderer)
10236 {
10237 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10238 {
10239 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10240 attr->SetRenderer(renderer);
10241 attr->DecRef();
10242 }
10243 }
10244
10245 void wxGrid::SetCellEditor(int row, int col, wxGridCellEditor* editor)
10246 {
10247 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10248 {
10249 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10250 attr->SetEditor(editor);
10251 attr->DecRef();
10252 }
10253 }
10254
10255 void wxGrid::SetReadOnly(int row, int col, bool isReadOnly)
10256 {
10257 if ( CanHaveAttributes() )
10258 {
10259 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetOrCreateCellAttr(row, col);
10260 attr->SetReadOnly(isReadOnly);
10261 attr->DecRef();
10262 }
10263 }
10264
10265 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10266 // Data type registration
10267 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10268
10269 void wxGrid::RegisterDataType(const wxString& typeName,
10270 wxGridCellRenderer* renderer,
10271 wxGridCellEditor* editor)
10272 {
10273 m_typeRegistry->RegisterDataType(typeName, renderer, editor);
10274 }
10275
10276
10277 wxGridCellEditor * wxGrid::GetDefaultEditorForCell(int row, int col) const
10278 {
10279 wxString typeName = m_table->GetTypeName(row, col);
10280 return GetDefaultEditorForType(typeName);
10281 }
10282
10283 wxGridCellRenderer * wxGrid::GetDefaultRendererForCell(int row, int col) const
10284 {
10285 wxString typeName = m_table->GetTypeName(row, col);
10286 return GetDefaultRendererForType(typeName);
10287 }
10288
10289 wxGridCellEditor * wxGrid::GetDefaultEditorForType(const wxString& typeName) const
10290 {
10291 int index = m_typeRegistry->FindOrCloneDataType(typeName);
10292 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
10293 {
10294 wxFAIL_MSG(wxString::Format(wxT("Unknown data type name [%s]"), typeName.c_str()));
10295
10296 return NULL;
10297 }
10298
10299 return m_typeRegistry->GetEditor(index);
10300 }
10301
10302 wxGridCellRenderer * wxGrid::GetDefaultRendererForType(const wxString& typeName) const
10303 {
10304 int index = m_typeRegistry->FindOrCloneDataType(typeName);
10305 if ( index == wxNOT_FOUND )
10306 {
10307 wxFAIL_MSG(wxString::Format(wxT("Unknown data type name [%s]"), typeName.c_str()));
10308
10309 return NULL;
10310 }
10311
10312 return m_typeRegistry->GetRenderer(index);
10313 }
10314
10315 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10316 // row/col size
10317 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10318
10319 void wxGrid::EnableDragRowSize( bool enable )
10320 {
10321 m_canDragRowSize = enable;
10322 }
10323
10324 void wxGrid::EnableDragColSize( bool enable )
10325 {
10326 m_canDragColSize = enable;
10327 }
10328
10329 void wxGrid::EnableDragGridSize( bool enable )
10330 {
10331 m_canDragGridSize = enable;
10332 }
10333
10334 void wxGrid::EnableDragCell( bool enable )
10335 {
10336 m_canDragCell = enable;
10337 }
10338
10339 void wxGrid::SetDefaultRowSize( int height, bool resizeExistingRows )
10340 {
10341 m_defaultRowHeight = wxMax( height, m_minAcceptableRowHeight );
10342
10343 if ( resizeExistingRows )
10344 {
10345 // since we are resizing all rows to the default row size,
10346 // we can simply clear the row heights and row bottoms
10347 // arrays (which also allows us to take advantage of
10348 // some speed optimisations)
10349 m_rowHeights.Empty();
10350 m_rowBottoms.Empty();
10351 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10352 CalcDimensions();
10353 }
10354 }
10355
10356 void wxGrid::SetRowSize( int row, int height )
10357 {
10358 wxCHECK_RET( row >= 0 && row < m_numRows, _T("invalid row index") );
10359
10360 // if < 0 then calculate new height from label
10361 if ( height < 0 )
10362 {
10363 long w, h;
10364 wxArrayString lines;
10365 wxClientDC dc(m_rowLabelWin);
10366 dc.SetFont(GetLabelFont());
10367 StringToLines(GetRowLabelValue( row ), lines);
10368 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &w, &h );
10369 //check that it is not less than the minimal height
10370 height = wxMax(h, GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight());
10371 }
10372
10373 // See comment in SetColSize
10374 if ( height < GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight())
10375 return;
10376
10377 if ( m_rowHeights.IsEmpty() )
10378 {
10379 // need to really create the array
10380 InitRowHeights();
10381 }
10382
10383 int h = wxMax( 0, height );
10384 int diff = h - m_rowHeights[row];
10385
10386 m_rowHeights[row] = h;
10387 for ( int i = row; i < m_numRows; i++ )
10388 {
10389 m_rowBottoms[i] += diff;
10390 }
10391
10392 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10393 CalcDimensions();
10394 }
10395
10396 void wxGrid::SetDefaultColSize( int width, bool resizeExistingCols )
10397 {
10398 // we dont allow zero default column width
10399 m_defaultColWidth = wxMax( wxMax( width, m_minAcceptableColWidth ), 1 );
10400
10401 if ( resizeExistingCols )
10402 {
10403 // since we are resizing all columns to the default column size,
10404 // we can simply clear the col widths and col rights
10405 // arrays (which also allows us to take advantage of
10406 // some speed optimisations)
10407 m_colWidths.Empty();
10408 m_colRights.Empty();
10409 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10410 CalcDimensions();
10411 }
10412 }
10413
10414 void wxGrid::SetColSize( int col, int width )
10415 {
10416 wxCHECK_RET( col >= 0 && col < m_numCols, _T("invalid column index") );
10417
10418 // if < 0 then calculate new width from label
10419 if ( width < 0 )
10420 {
10421 long w, h;
10422 wxArrayString lines;
10423 wxClientDC dc(m_colLabelWin);
10424 dc.SetFont(GetLabelFont());
10425 StringToLines(GetColLabelValue(col), lines);
10426 if ( GetColLabelTextOrientation() == wxHORIZONTAL )
10427 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &w, &h );
10428 else
10429 GetTextBoxSize( dc, lines, &h, &w );
10430 width = w + 6;
10431 //check that it is not less than the minimal width
10432 width = wxMax(width, GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth());
10433 }
10434
10435 // should we check that it's bigger than GetColMinimalWidth(col) here?
10436 // (VZ)
10437 // No, because it is reasonable to assume the library user know's
10438 // what he is doing. However we should test against the weaker
10439 // constraint of minimalAcceptableWidth, as this breaks rendering
10440 //
10441 // This test then fixes sf.net bug #645734
10442
10443 if ( width < GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth() )
10444 return;
10445
10446 if ( m_colWidths.IsEmpty() )
10447 {
10448 // need to really create the array
10449 InitColWidths();
10450 }
10451
10452 int w = wxMax( 0, width );
10453 int diff = w - m_colWidths[col];
10454 m_colWidths[col] = w;
10455
10456 for ( int colPos = GetColPos(col); colPos < m_numCols; colPos++ )
10457 {
10458 m_colRights[GetColAt(colPos)] += diff;
10459 }
10460
10461 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10462 CalcDimensions();
10463 }
10464
10465 void wxGrid::SetColMinimalWidth( int col, int width )
10466 {
10467 if (width > GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth())
10468 {
10469 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)col;
10470 m_colMinWidths[key] = width;
10471 }
10472 }
10473
10474 void wxGrid::SetRowMinimalHeight( int row, int width )
10475 {
10476 if (width > GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight())
10477 {
10478 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)row;
10479 m_rowMinHeights[key] = width;
10480 }
10481 }
10482
10483 int wxGrid::GetColMinimalWidth(int col) const
10484 {
10485 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)col;
10486 wxLongToLongHashMap::const_iterator it = m_colMinWidths.find(key);
10487
10488 return it != m_colMinWidths.end() ? (int)it->second : m_minAcceptableColWidth;
10489 }
10490
10491 int wxGrid::GetRowMinimalHeight(int row) const
10492 {
10493 wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type key = (wxLongToLongHashMap::key_type)row;
10494 wxLongToLongHashMap::const_iterator it = m_rowMinHeights.find(key);
10495
10496 return it != m_rowMinHeights.end() ? (int)it->second : m_minAcceptableRowHeight;
10497 }
10498
10499 void wxGrid::SetColMinimalAcceptableWidth( int width )
10500 {
10501 // We do allow a width of 0 since this gives us
10502 // an easy way to temporarily hiding columns.
10503 if ( width >= 0 )
10504 m_minAcceptableColWidth = width;
10505 }
10506
10507 void wxGrid::SetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight( int height )
10508 {
10509 // We do allow a height of 0 since this gives us
10510 // an easy way to temporarily hiding rows.
10511 if ( height >= 0 )
10512 m_minAcceptableRowHeight = height;
10513 }
10514
10515 int wxGrid::GetColMinimalAcceptableWidth() const
10516 {
10517 return m_minAcceptableColWidth;
10518 }
10519
10520 int wxGrid::GetRowMinimalAcceptableHeight() const
10521 {
10522 return m_minAcceptableRowHeight;
10523 }
10524
10525 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10526 // auto sizing
10527 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10528
10529 void
10530 wxGrid::AutoSizeColOrRow(int colOrRow, bool setAsMin, wxGridDirection direction)
10531 {
10532 const bool column = direction == wxGRID_COLUMN;
10533
10534 wxClientDC dc(m_gridWin);
10535
10536 // cancel editing of cell
10537 HideCellEditControl();
10538 SaveEditControlValue();
10539
10540 // init both of them to avoid compiler warnings, even if we only need one
10541 int row = -1,
10542 col = -1;
10543 if ( column )
10544 col = colOrRow;
10545 else
10546 row = colOrRow;
10547
10548 wxCoord extent, extentMax = 0;
10549 int max = column ? m_numRows : m_numCols;
10550 for ( int rowOrCol = 0; rowOrCol < max; rowOrCol++ )
10551 {
10552 if ( column )
10553 row = rowOrCol;
10554 else
10555 col = rowOrCol;
10556
10557 wxGridCellAttr *attr = GetCellAttr(row, col);
10558 wxGridCellRenderer *renderer = attr->GetRenderer(this, row, col);
10559 if ( renderer )
10560 {
10561 wxSize size = renderer->GetBestSize(*this, *attr, dc, row, col);
10562 extent = column ? size.x : size.y;
10563 if ( extent > extentMax )
10564 extentMax = extent;
10565
10566 renderer->DecRef();
10567 }
10568
10569 attr->DecRef();
10570 }
10571
10572 // now also compare with the column label extent
10573 wxCoord w, h;
10574 dc.SetFont( GetLabelFont() );
10575
10576 if ( column )
10577 {
10578 dc.GetMultiLineTextExtent( GetColLabelValue(col), &w, &h );
10579 if ( GetColLabelTextOrientation() == wxVERTICAL )
10580 w = h;
10581 }
10582 else
10583 dc.GetMultiLineTextExtent( GetRowLabelValue(row), &w, &h );
10584
10585 extent = column ? w : h;
10586 if ( extent > extentMax )
10587 extentMax = extent;
10588
10589 if ( !extentMax )
10590 {
10591 // empty column - give default extent (notice that if extentMax is less
10592 // than default extent but != 0, it's OK)
10593 extentMax = column ? m_defaultColWidth : m_defaultRowHeight;
10594 }
10595 else
10596 {
10597 if ( column )
10598 // leave some space around text
10599 extentMax += 10;
10600 else
10601 extentMax += 6;
10602 }
10603
10604 if ( column )
10605 {
10606 // Ensure automatic width is not less than minimal width. See the
10607 // comment in SetColSize() for explanation of why this isn't done
10608 // in SetColSize().
10609 if ( !setAsMin )
10610 extentMax = wxMax(extentMax, GetColMinimalWidth(col));
10611
10612 SetColSize( col, extentMax );
10613 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10614 {
10615 int cw, ch, dummy;
10616 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
10617 wxRect rect ( CellToRect( 0, col ) );
10618 rect.y = 0;
10619 CalcScrolledPosition(rect.x, 0, &rect.x, &dummy);
10620 rect.width = cw - rect.x;
10621 rect.height = m_colLabelHeight;
10622 m_colLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
10623 }
10624 }
10625 else
10626 {
10627 // Ensure automatic width is not less than minimal height. See the
10628 // comment in SetColSize() for explanation of why this isn't done
10629 // in SetRowSize().
10630 if ( !setAsMin )
10631 extentMax = wxMax(extentMax, GetRowMinimalHeight(row));
10632
10633 SetRowSize(row, extentMax);
10634 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10635 {
10636 int cw, ch, dummy;
10637 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
10638 wxRect rect( CellToRect( row, 0 ) );
10639 rect.x = 0;
10640 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &dummy, &rect.y);
10641 rect.width = m_rowLabelWidth;
10642 rect.height = ch - rect.y;
10643 m_rowLabelWin->Refresh( true, &rect );
10644 }
10645 }
10646
10647 if ( setAsMin )
10648 {
10649 if ( column )
10650 SetColMinimalWidth(col, extentMax);
10651 else
10652 SetRowMinimalHeight(row, extentMax);
10653 }
10654 }
10655
10656 wxCoord wxGrid::CalcColOrRowLabelAreaMinSize(wxGridDirection direction)
10657 {
10658 // calculate size for the rows or columns?
10659 const bool calcRows = direction == wxGRID_ROW;
10660
10661 wxClientDC dc(calcRows ? GetGridRowLabelWindow()
10662 : GetGridColLabelWindow());
10663 dc.SetFont(GetLabelFont());
10664
10665 // which dimension should we take into account for calculations?
10666 //
10667 // for columns, the text can be only horizontal so it's easy but for rows
10668 // we also have to take into account the text orientation
10669 const bool
10670 useWidth = calcRows || (GetColLabelTextOrientation() == wxVERTICAL);
10671
10672 wxArrayString lines;
10673 wxCoord extentMax = 0;
10674
10675 const int numRowsOrCols = calcRows ? m_numRows : m_numCols;
10676 for ( int rowOrCol = 0; rowOrCol < numRowsOrCols; rowOrCol++ )
10677 {
10678 lines.Clear();
10679
10680 wxString label = calcRows ? GetRowLabelValue(rowOrCol)
10681 : GetColLabelValue(rowOrCol);
10682 StringToLines(label, lines);
10683
10684 long w, h;
10685 GetTextBoxSize(dc, lines, &w, &h);
10686
10687 const wxCoord extent = useWidth ? w : h;
10688 if ( extent > extentMax )
10689 extentMax = extent;
10690 }
10691
10692 if ( !extentMax )
10693 {
10694 // empty column - give default extent (notice that if extentMax is less
10695 // than default extent but != 0, it's OK)
10696 extentMax = calcRows ? GetDefaultRowLabelSize()
10697 : GetDefaultColLabelSize();
10698 }
10699
10700 // leave some space around text (taken from AutoSizeColOrRow)
10701 if ( calcRows )
10702 extentMax += 10;
10703 else
10704 extentMax += 6;
10705
10706 return extentMax;
10707 }
10708
10709 int wxGrid::SetOrCalcColumnSizes(bool calcOnly, bool setAsMin)
10710 {
10711 int width = m_rowLabelWidth;
10712
10713 wxGridUpdateLocker locker;
10714 if(!calcOnly)
10715 locker.Create(this);
10716
10717 for ( int col = 0; col < m_numCols; col++ )
10718 {
10719 if ( !calcOnly )
10720 AutoSizeColumn(col, setAsMin);
10721
10722 width += GetColWidth(col);
10723 }
10724
10725 return width;
10726 }
10727
10728 int wxGrid::SetOrCalcRowSizes(bool calcOnly, bool setAsMin)
10729 {
10730 int height = m_colLabelHeight;
10731
10732 wxGridUpdateLocker locker;
10733 if(!calcOnly)
10734 locker.Create(this);
10735
10736 for ( int row = 0; row < m_numRows; row++ )
10737 {
10738 if ( !calcOnly )
10739 AutoSizeRow(row, setAsMin);
10740
10741 height += GetRowHeight(row);
10742 }
10743
10744 return height;
10745 }
10746
10747 void wxGrid::AutoSize()
10748 {
10749 wxGridUpdateLocker locker(this);
10750
10751 // we need to round up the size of the scrollable area to a multiple of
10752 // scroll step to ensure that we don't get the scrollbars when we're sized
10753 // exactly to fit our contents
10754 wxSize size(SetOrCalcColumnSizes(false) - m_rowLabelWidth + m_extraWidth,
10755 SetOrCalcRowSizes(false) - m_colLabelHeight + m_extraHeight);
10756 wxSize sizeFit(GetScrollX(size.x) * GetScrollLineX(),
10757 GetScrollY(size.y) * GetScrollLineY());
10758
10759 // distribute the extra space between the columns/rows to avoid having
10760 // extra white space
10761 wxCoord diff = sizeFit.x - size.x;
10762 if ( diff && m_numCols )
10763 {
10764 // try to resize the columns uniformly
10765 wxCoord diffPerCol = diff / m_numCols;
10766 if ( diffPerCol )
10767 {
10768 for ( int col = 0; col < m_numCols; col++ )
10769 {
10770 SetColSize(col, GetColWidth(col) + diffPerCol);
10771 }
10772 }
10773
10774 // add remaining amount to the last columns
10775 diff -= diffPerCol * m_numCols;
10776 if ( diff )
10777 {
10778 for ( int col = m_numCols - 1; col >= m_numCols - diff; col-- )
10779 {
10780 SetColSize(col, GetColWidth(col) + 1);
10781 }
10782 }
10783 }
10784
10785 // same for rows
10786 diff = sizeFit.y - size.y;
10787 if ( diff && m_numRows )
10788 {
10789 // try to resize the columns uniformly
10790 wxCoord diffPerRow = diff / m_numRows;
10791 if ( diffPerRow )
10792 {
10793 for ( int row = 0; row < m_numRows; row++ )
10794 {
10795 SetRowSize(row, GetRowHeight(row) + diffPerRow);
10796 }
10797 }
10798
10799 // add remaining amount to the last rows
10800 diff -= diffPerRow * m_numRows;
10801 if ( diff )
10802 {
10803 for ( int row = m_numRows - 1; row >= m_numRows - diff; row-- )
10804 {
10805 SetRowSize(row, GetRowHeight(row) + 1);
10806 }
10807 }
10808 }
10809
10810 // we know that we're not going to have scrollbars so disable them now to
10811 // avoid trouble in SetClientSize() which can otherwise set the correct
10812 // client size but also leave space for (not needed any more) scrollbars
10813 SetScrollbars(0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, true);
10814 SetClientSize(sizeFit.x + m_rowLabelWidth, sizeFit.y + m_colLabelHeight);
10815 }
10816
10817 void wxGrid::AutoSizeRowLabelSize( int row )
10818 {
10819 // Hide the edit control, so it
10820 // won't interfere with drag-shrinking.
10821 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
10822 {
10823 HideCellEditControl();
10824 SaveEditControlValue();
10825 }
10826
10827 // autosize row height depending on label text
10828 SetRowSize(row, -1);
10829 ForceRefresh();
10830 }
10831
10832 void wxGrid::AutoSizeColLabelSize( int col )
10833 {
10834 // Hide the edit control, so it
10835 // won't interfere with drag-shrinking.
10836 if ( IsCellEditControlShown() )
10837 {
10838 HideCellEditControl();
10839 SaveEditControlValue();
10840 }
10841
10842 // autosize column width depending on label text
10843 SetColSize(col, -1);
10844 ForceRefresh();
10845 }
10846
10847 wxSize wxGrid::DoGetBestSize() const
10848 {
10849 wxGrid *self = (wxGrid *)this; // const_cast
10850
10851 // we do the same as in AutoSize() here with the exception that we don't
10852 // change the column/row sizes, only calculate them
10853 wxSize size(self->SetOrCalcColumnSizes(true) - m_rowLabelWidth + m_extraWidth,
10854 self->SetOrCalcRowSizes(true) - m_colLabelHeight + m_extraHeight);
10855 wxSize sizeFit(GetScrollX(size.x) * GetScrollLineX(),
10856 GetScrollY(size.y) * GetScrollLineY());
10857
10858 // NOTE: This size should be cached, but first we need to add calls to
10859 // InvalidateBestSize everywhere that could change the results of this
10860 // calculation.
10861 // CacheBestSize(size);
10862
10863 return wxSize(sizeFit.x + m_rowLabelWidth, sizeFit.y + m_colLabelHeight)
10864 + GetWindowBorderSize();
10865 }
10866
10867 void wxGrid::Fit()
10868 {
10869 AutoSize();
10870 }
10871
10872 wxPen& wxGrid::GetDividerPen() const
10873 {
10874 return wxNullPen;
10875 }
10876
10877 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10878 // cell value accessor functions
10879 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10880
10881 void wxGrid::SetCellValue( int row, int col, const wxString& s )
10882 {
10883 if ( m_table )
10884 {
10885 m_table->SetValue( row, col, s );
10886 if ( !GetBatchCount() )
10887 {
10888 int dummy;
10889 wxRect rect( CellToRect( row, col ) );
10890 rect.x = 0;
10891 rect.width = m_gridWin->GetClientSize().GetWidth();
10892 CalcScrolledPosition(0, rect.y, &dummy, &rect.y);
10893 m_gridWin->Refresh( false, &rect );
10894 }
10895
10896 if ( m_currentCellCoords.GetRow() == row &&
10897 m_currentCellCoords.GetCol() == col &&
10898 IsCellEditControlShown())
10899 // Note: If we are using IsCellEditControlEnabled,
10900 // this interacts badly with calling SetCellValue from
10901 // an EVT_GRID_CELL_CHANGE handler.
10902 {
10903 HideCellEditControl();
10904 ShowCellEditControl(); // will reread data from table
10905 }
10906 }
10907 }
10908
10909 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10910 // block, row and column selection
10911 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10912
10913 void wxGrid::SelectRow( int row, bool addToSelected )
10914 {
10915 if ( IsSelection() && !addToSelected )
10916 ClearSelection();
10917
10918 if ( m_selection )
10919 m_selection->SelectRow( row, false, addToSelected );
10920 }
10921
10922 void wxGrid::SelectCol( int col, bool addToSelected )
10923 {
10924 if ( IsSelection() && !addToSelected )
10925 ClearSelection();
10926
10927 if ( m_selection )
10928 m_selection->SelectCol( col, false, addToSelected );
10929 }
10930
10931 void wxGrid::SelectBlock( int topRow, int leftCol, int bottomRow, int rightCol,
10932 bool addToSelected )
10933 {
10934 if ( IsSelection() && !addToSelected )
10935 ClearSelection();
10936
10937 if ( m_selection )
10938 m_selection->SelectBlock( topRow, leftCol, bottomRow, rightCol,
10939 false, addToSelected );
10940 }
10941
10942 void wxGrid::SelectAll()
10943 {
10944 if ( m_numRows > 0 && m_numCols > 0 )
10945 {
10946 if ( m_selection )
10947 m_selection->SelectBlock( 0, 0, m_numRows - 1, m_numCols - 1 );
10948 }
10949 }
10950
10951 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10952 // cell, row and col deselection
10953 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
10954
10955 void wxGrid::DeselectRow( int row )
10956 {
10957 if ( !m_selection )
10958 return;
10959
10960 if ( m_selection->GetSelectionMode() == wxGrid::wxGridSelectRows )
10961 {
10962 if ( m_selection->IsInSelection(row, 0 ) )
10963 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(row, 0);
10964 }
10965 else
10966 {
10967 int nCols = GetNumberCols();
10968 for ( int i = 0; i < nCols; i++ )
10969 {
10970 if ( m_selection->IsInSelection(row, i ) )
10971 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(row, i);
10972 }
10973 }
10974 }
10975
10976 void wxGrid::DeselectCol( int col )
10977 {
10978 if ( !m_selection )
10979 return;
10980
10981 if ( m_selection->GetSelectionMode() == wxGrid::wxGridSelectColumns )
10982 {
10983 if ( m_selection->IsInSelection(0, col ) )
10984 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(0, col);
10985 }
10986 else
10987 {
10988 int nRows = GetNumberRows();
10989 for ( int i = 0; i < nRows; i++ )
10990 {
10991 if ( m_selection->IsInSelection(i, col ) )
10992 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(i, col);
10993 }
10994 }
10995 }
10996
10997 void wxGrid::DeselectCell( int row, int col )
10998 {
10999 if ( m_selection && m_selection->IsInSelection(row, col) )
11000 m_selection->ToggleCellSelection(row, col);
11001 }
11002
11003 bool wxGrid::IsSelection() const
11004 {
11005 return ( m_selection && (m_selection->IsSelection() ||
11006 ( m_selectingTopLeft != wxGridNoCellCoords &&
11007 m_selectingBottomRight != wxGridNoCellCoords) ) );
11008 }
11009
11010 bool wxGrid::IsInSelection( int row, int col ) const
11011 {
11012 return ( m_selection && (m_selection->IsInSelection( row, col ) ||
11013 ( row >= m_selectingTopLeft.GetRow() &&
11014 col >= m_selectingTopLeft.GetCol() &&
11015 row <= m_selectingBottomRight.GetRow() &&
11016 col <= m_selectingBottomRight.GetCol() )) );
11017 }
11018
11019 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::GetSelectedCells() const
11020 {
11021 if (!m_selection)
11022 {
11023 wxGridCellCoordsArray a;
11024 return a;
11025 }
11026
11027 return m_selection->m_cellSelection;
11028 }
11029
11030 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::GetSelectionBlockTopLeft() const
11031 {
11032 if (!m_selection)
11033 {
11034 wxGridCellCoordsArray a;
11035 return a;
11036 }
11037
11038 return m_selection->m_blockSelectionTopLeft;
11039 }
11040
11041 wxGridCellCoordsArray wxGrid::GetSelectionBlockBottomRight() const
11042 {
11043 if (!m_selection)
11044 {
11045 wxGridCellCoordsArray a;
11046 return a;
11047 }
11048
11049 return m_selection->m_blockSelectionBottomRight;
11050 }
11051
11052 wxArrayInt wxGrid::GetSelectedRows() const
11053 {
11054 if (!m_selection)
11055 {
11056 wxArrayInt a;
11057 return a;
11058 }
11059
11060 return m_selection->m_rowSelection;
11061 }
11062
11063 wxArrayInt wxGrid::GetSelectedCols() const
11064 {
11065 if (!m_selection)
11066 {
11067 wxArrayInt a;
11068 return a;
11069 }
11070
11071 return m_selection->m_colSelection;
11072 }
11073
11074 void wxGrid::ClearSelection()
11075 {
11076 wxRect r1 = BlockToDeviceRect( m_selectingTopLeft, m_selectingBottomRight);
11077 wxRect r2 = BlockToDeviceRect( m_currentCellCoords, m_selectingKeyboard );
11078 m_selectingTopLeft =
11079 m_selectingBottomRight =
11080 m_selectingKeyboard = wxGridNoCellCoords;
11081 Refresh( false, &r1 );
11082 Refresh( false, &r2 );
11083 if ( m_selection )
11084 m_selection->ClearSelection();
11085 }
11086
11087 // This function returns the rectangle that encloses the given block
11088 // in device coords clipped to the client size of the grid window.
11089 //
11090 wxRect wxGrid::BlockToDeviceRect( const wxGridCellCoords& topLeft,
11091 const wxGridCellCoords& bottomRight ) const
11092 {
11093 wxRect resultRect;
11094 wxRect tempCellRect = CellToRect(topLeft);
11095 if ( tempCellRect != wxGridNoCellRect )
11096 {
11097 resultRect = tempCellRect;
11098 }
11099 else
11100 {
11101 resultRect = wxRect(0, 0, 0, 0);
11102 }
11103
11104 tempCellRect = CellToRect(bottomRight);
11105 if ( tempCellRect != wxGridNoCellRect )
11106 {
11107 resultRect += tempCellRect;
11108 }
11109 else
11110 {
11111 // If both inputs were "wxGridNoCellRect," then there's nothing to do.
11112 return wxGridNoCellRect;
11113 }
11114
11115 // Ensure that left/right and top/bottom pairs are in order.
11116 int left = resultRect.GetLeft();
11117 int top = resultRect.GetTop();
11118 int right = resultRect.GetRight();
11119 int bottom = resultRect.GetBottom();
11120
11121 int leftCol = topLeft.GetCol();
11122 int topRow = topLeft.GetRow();
11123 int rightCol = bottomRight.GetCol();
11124 int bottomRow = bottomRight.GetRow();
11125
11126 if (left > right)
11127 {
11128 int tmp = left;
11129 left = right;
11130 right = tmp;
11131
11132 tmp = leftCol;
11133 leftCol = rightCol;
11134 rightCol = tmp;
11135 }
11136
11137 if (top > bottom)
11138 {
11139 int tmp = top;
11140 top = bottom;
11141 bottom = tmp;
11142
11143 tmp = topRow;
11144 topRow = bottomRow;
11145 bottomRow = tmp;
11146 }
11147
11148 // The following loop is ONLY necessary to detect and handle merged cells.
11149 int cw, ch;
11150 m_gridWin->GetClientSize( &cw, &ch );
11151
11152 // Get the origin coordinates: notice that they will be negative if the
11153 // grid is scrolled downwards/to the right.
11154 int gridOriginX = 0;
11155 int gridOriginY = 0;
11156 CalcScrolledPosition(gridOriginX, gridOriginY, &gridOriginX, &gridOriginY);
11157
11158 int onScreenLeftmostCol = internalXToCol(-gridOriginX);
11159 int onScreenUppermostRow = internalYToRow(-gridOriginY);
11160
11161 int onScreenRightmostCol = internalXToCol(-gridOriginX + cw);
11162 int onScreenBottommostRow = internalYToRow(-gridOriginY + ch);
11163
11164 // Bound our loop so that we only examine the portion of the selected block
11165 // that is shown on screen. Therefore, we compare the Top-Left block values
11166 // to the Top-Left screen values, and the Bottom-Right block values to the
11167 // Bottom-Right screen values, choosing appropriately.
11168 const int visibleTopRow = wxMax(topRow, onScreenUppermostRow);
11169 const int visibleBottomRow = wxMin(bottomRow, onScreenBottommostRow);
11170 const int visibleLeftCol = wxMax(leftCol, onScreenLeftmostCol);
11171 const int visibleRightCol = wxMin(rightCol, onScreenRightmostCol);
11172
11173 for ( int j = visibleTopRow; j <= visibleBottomRow; j++ )
11174 {
11175 for ( int i = visibleLeftCol; i <= visibleRightCol; i++ )
11176 {
11177 if ( (j == visibleTopRow) || (j == visibleBottomRow) ||
11178 (i == visibleLeftCol) || (i == visibleRightCol) )
11179 {
11180 tempCellRect = CellToRect( j, i );
11181
11182 if (tempCellRect.x < left)
11183 left = tempCellRect.x;
11184 if (tempCellRect.y < top)
11185 top = tempCellRect.y;
11186 if (tempCellRect.x + tempCellRect.width > right)
11187 right = tempCellRect.x + tempCellRect.width;
11188 if (tempCellRect.y + tempCellRect.height > bottom)
11189 bottom = tempCellRect.y + tempCellRect.height;
11190 }
11191 else
11192 {
11193 i = visibleRightCol; // jump over inner cells.
11194 }
11195 }
11196 }
11197
11198 // Convert to scrolled coords
11199 CalcScrolledPosition( left, top, &left, &top );
11200 CalcScrolledPosition( right, bottom, &right, &bottom );
11201
11202 if (right < 0 || bottom < 0 || left > cw || top > ch)
11203 return wxRect(0,0,0,0);
11204
11205 resultRect.SetLeft( wxMax(0, left) );
11206 resultRect.SetTop( wxMax(0, top) );
11207 resultRect.SetRight( wxMin(cw, right) );
11208 resultRect.SetBottom( wxMin(ch, bottom) );
11209
11210 return resultRect;
11211 }
11212
11213 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
11214 // drop target
11215 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
11216
11217 #if wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
11218
11219 // this allow setting drop target directly on wxGrid
11220 void wxGrid::SetDropTarget(wxDropTarget *dropTarget)
11221 {
11222 GetGridWindow()->SetDropTarget(dropTarget);
11223 }
11224
11225 #endif // wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
11226
11227 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
11228 // grid event classes
11229 // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
11230
11231 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridEvent, wxNotifyEvent )
11232
11233 wxGridEvent::wxGridEvent( int id, wxEventType type, wxObject* obj,
11234 int row, int col, int x, int y, bool sel,
11235 bool control, bool shift, bool alt, bool meta )
11236 : wxNotifyEvent( type, id )
11237 {
11238 m_row = row;
11239 m_col = col;
11240 m_x = x;
11241 m_y = y;
11242 m_selecting = sel;
11243 m_control = control;
11244 m_shift = shift;
11245 m_alt = alt;
11246 m_meta = meta;
11247
11248 SetEventObject(obj);
11249 }
11250
11251
11252 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridSizeEvent, wxNotifyEvent )
11253
11254 wxGridSizeEvent::wxGridSizeEvent( int id, wxEventType type, wxObject* obj,
11255 int rowOrCol, int x, int y,
11256 bool control, bool shift, bool alt, bool meta )
11257 : wxNotifyEvent( type, id )
11258 {
11259 m_rowOrCol = rowOrCol;
11260 m_x = x;
11261 m_y = y;
11262 m_control = control;
11263 m_shift = shift;
11264 m_alt = alt;
11265 m_meta = meta;
11266
11267 SetEventObject(obj);
11268 }
11269
11270
11271 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS( wxGridRangeSelectEvent, wxNotifyEvent )
11272
11273 wxGridRangeSelectEvent::wxGridRangeSelectEvent(int id, wxEventType type, wxObject* obj,
11274 const wxGridCellCoords& topLeft,
11275 const wxGridCellCoords& bottomRight,
11276 bool sel, bool control,
11277 bool shift, bool alt, bool meta )
11278 : wxNotifyEvent( type, id )
11279 {
11280 m_topLeft = topLeft;
11281 m_bottomRight = bottomRight;
11282 m_selecting = sel;
11283 m_control = control;
11284 m_shift = shift;
11285 m_alt = alt;
11286 m_meta = meta;
11287
11288 SetEventObject(obj);
11289 }
11290
11291
11292 IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxGridEditorCreatedEvent, wxCommandEvent)
11293
11294 wxGridEditorCreatedEvent::wxGridEditorCreatedEvent(int id, wxEventType type,
11295 wxObject* obj, int row,
11296 int col, wxControl* ctrl)
11297 : wxCommandEvent(type, id)
11298 {
11299 SetEventObject(obj);
11300 m_row = row;
11301 m_col = col;
11302 m_ctrl = ctrl;
11303 }
11304
11305 #endif // wxUSE_GRID